* eval.c (evaluate_subexp_for_address): Clarify error message.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824 message like this one:
1825
1826 @smallexample
1827 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828 Try "help target" or "continue".
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833 first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840 divided into four categories:
1841
1842 @table @asis
1843 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1844 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848 the arguments.
1849 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{environment.}
1854 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1860 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868 set a different device for your program.
1869 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871 @cindex pipes
1872 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875 wrong program.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887 your current breakpoints.
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex start
1891 @item start
1892 @cindex run to main procedure
1893 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898 procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902 the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904 @cindex elaboration phase
1905 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911 will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923 elaboration code before running your program.
1924
1925 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1926 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1927 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1928 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1929 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1930 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1931 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1932 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1933 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1934 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1935 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1936
1937 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1938 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1939 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1940 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1941
1942 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1943 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1944 environment:
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1948 (@value{GDBP}) run
1949 @end smallexample
1950
1951 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1952 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1953
1954 @end table
1955
1956 @node Arguments
1957 @section Your Program's Arguments
1958
1959 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1960 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1961 @code{run} command.
1962 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1963 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1964 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1965 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1966 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1967
1968 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1969 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1970 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1971 the program, not by the shell.
1972
1973 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1974 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1975
1976 @table @code
1977 @kindex set args
1978 @item set args
1979 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1980 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1981 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1982 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1983 it again without arguments.
1984
1985 @kindex show args
1986 @item show args
1987 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1988 @end table
1989
1990 @node Environment
1991 @section Your Program's Environment
1992
1993 @cindex environment (of your program)
1994 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1995 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1996 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1997 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1998 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1999 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2000 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex path
2004 @item path @var{directory}
2005 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2006 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2007 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2008 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2009 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2010 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2011 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2012
2013 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2014 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2015 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2016 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2017 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2018 @var{directory} to the search path.
2019 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2020 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2021
2022 @kindex show paths
2023 @item show paths
2024 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2025 environment variable).
2026
2027 @kindex show environment
2028 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2029 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2030 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2031 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2032 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2033
2034 @kindex set environment
2035 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2036 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2037 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2038 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2039 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2040 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2041 null value.
2042 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2043 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2044
2045 For example, this command:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 set env USER = foo
2049 @end smallexample
2050
2051 @noindent
2052 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2053 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2054 are not actually required.)
2055
2056 @kindex unset environment
2057 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2058 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2059 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2060 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2061 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2062 @end table
2063
2064 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2065 the shell indicated
2066 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2067 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2068 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2069 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2070 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2071 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2072 @file{.profile}.
2073
2074 @node Working Directory
2075 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2076
2077 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2078 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2079 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2080 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2081 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2082 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2083
2084 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2085 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2086 Specify Files}.
2087
2088 @table @code
2089 @kindex cd
2090 @cindex change working directory
2091 @item cd @var{directory}
2092 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2093
2094 @kindex pwd
2095 @item pwd
2096 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2097 @end table
2098
2099 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2100 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2101 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2102 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2103 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2104 current working directory of the debuggee.
2105
2106 @node Input/Output
2107 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2108
2109 @cindex redirection
2110 @cindex i/o
2111 @cindex terminal
2112 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2113 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2114 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2115 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2116 running your program.
2117
2118 @table @code
2119 @kindex info terminal
2120 @item info terminal
2121 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2122 program is using.
2123 @end table
2124
2125 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2126 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2127
2128 @smallexample
2129 run > outfile
2130 @end smallexample
2131
2132 @noindent
2133 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2134
2135 @kindex tty
2136 @cindex controlling terminal
2137 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2138 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2139 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2140 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2141 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2142
2143 @smallexample
2144 tty /dev/ttyb
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 @noindent
2148 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2149 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2150 that as their controlling terminal.
2151
2152 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2153 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2154 terminal.
2155
2156 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2157 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2158 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2159 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2160
2161 @cindex inferior tty
2162 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2163 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2164 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2165 program.
2166
2167 @table @code
2168 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2169 @kindex set inferior-tty
2170 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2171
2172 @item show inferior-tty
2173 @kindex show inferior-tty
2174 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @node Attach
2178 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2179 @kindex attach
2180 @cindex attach
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @item attach @var{process-id}
2184 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2185 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2186 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2187 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2188 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2189
2190 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2191 executing the command.
2192 @end table
2193
2194 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2195 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2196 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2197 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2198
2199 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2200 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2201 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2202 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2203 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2204 Specify Files}.
2205
2206 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2207 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2208 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2209 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2210 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2211 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2212 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex detach
2216 @item detach
2217 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2218 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2219 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2220 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2221 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2222 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2223 executing the command.
2224 @end table
2225
2226 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2227 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2228 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2229 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2230 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2231 Messages}).
2232
2233 @node Kill Process
2234 @section Killing the Child Process
2235
2236 @table @code
2237 @kindex kill
2238 @item kill
2239 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2240 @end table
2241
2242 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2243 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2244 is running.
2245
2246 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2247 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2248 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2249 outside the debugger.
2250
2251 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2252 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2253 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2254 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2255 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2256 breakpoint settings).
2257
2258 @node Threads
2259 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2260
2261 @cindex threads of execution
2262 @cindex multiple threads
2263 @cindex switching threads
2264 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2265 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2266 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2267 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2268 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2269 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2270 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2271
2272 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2273 programs:
2274
2275 @itemize @bullet
2276 @item automatic notification of new threads
2277 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2278 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2279 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2280 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2281 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2282 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2283 messages on thread start and exit.
2284 @end itemize
2285
2286 @quotation
2287 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2288 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2289 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2290 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2291 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2292 like this:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2296 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2297 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2298 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2299 @end smallexample
2300 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2301 @c doesn't support threads"?
2302 @end quotation
2303
2304 @cindex focus of debugging
2305 @cindex current thread
2306 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2307 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2308 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2309 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2310 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2311
2312 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2313 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2314 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2315 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2316 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2317 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2318 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2319 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2320 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2321 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2322
2323 @smallexample
2324 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2325 @end smallexample
2326
2327 @noindent
2328 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2329 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2330 further qualifier.
2331
2332 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2333 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2334 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2335 @c program?
2336 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2337 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2338 @c threads ab initio?
2339
2340 @cindex thread number
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2344
2345 @table @code
2346 @kindex info threads
2347 @item info threads
2348 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2349 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2350
2351 @enumerate
2352 @item
2353 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2354
2355 @item
2356 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2357
2358 @item
2359 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2360 @end enumerate
2361
2362 @noindent
2363 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2364 indicates the current thread.
2365
2366 For example,
2367 @end table
2368 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2369
2370 @smallexample
2371 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2372 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2373 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2374 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2375 at threadtest.c:68
2376 @end smallexample
2377
2378 On HP-UX systems:
2379
2380 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2381 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2382 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2383 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2384 thread in your program.
2385
2386 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2387 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2388 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2389 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2390 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2391 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2392 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2393 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2394 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2395 HP-UX, you see
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2399 @end smallexample
2400
2401 @noindent
2402 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2403
2404 @table @code
2405 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2406 @item info threads
2407 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2408 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2409
2410 @enumerate
2411 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2412
2413 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2414
2415 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2416 @end enumerate
2417
2418 @noindent
2419 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2420 indicates the current thread.
2421
2422 For example,
2423 @end table
2424 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2428 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2429 at quicksort.c:137
2430 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2431 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2432 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2433 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2434 @end smallexample
2435
2436 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2437 Solaris-specific command:
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @item maint info sol-threads
2441 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2442 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2443 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2444 @end table
2445
2446 @table @code
2447 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2448 @item thread @var{threadno}
2449 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2450 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2451 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2452 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2453 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2457 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2458 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2459 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2460 @end smallexample
2461
2462 @noindent
2463 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2464 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2465 threads.
2466
2467 @kindex thread apply
2468 @cindex apply command to several threads
2469 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2470 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2471 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2472 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2473 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2474 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2475 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2476 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2477
2478 @kindex set print thread-events
2479 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2480 @item set print thread-events
2481 @itemx set print thread-events on
2482 @itemx set print thread-events off
2483 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2484 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2485 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2486 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2487 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2488
2489 @kindex show print thread-events
2490 @item show print thread-events
2491 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2492 have started and exited.
2493 @end table
2494
2495 @cindex automatic thread selection
2496 @cindex switching threads automatically
2497 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2498 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2499 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2500 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2501 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2502 thread.
2503
2504 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2505 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2506 programs with multiple threads.
2507
2508 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2509 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2510
2511 @node Processes
2512 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2513
2514 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2515 @cindex multiple processes
2516 @cindex processes, multiple
2517 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2518 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2519 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2520 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2521 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2522 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2523 will cause it to terminate.
2524
2525 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2526 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2527 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2528 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2529 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2530 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2531 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2532 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2533 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2534 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2535
2536 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2537 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2538 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2539 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2540
2541 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2542 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2543
2544 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2545 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2549 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2550 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2551 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2552 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2553
2554 @table @code
2555 @item parent
2556 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2557 unimpeded. This is the default.
2558
2559 @item child
2560 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2561 unimpeded.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2566 @item show follow-fork-mode
2567 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2568 @end table
2569
2570 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2571 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2572 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2576 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2577 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2578 retain debugger control over them both.
2579
2580 @table @code
2581 @item on
2582 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2583 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2584 independently. This is the default.
2585
2586 @item off
2587 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2588 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2589 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2590 is held suspended.
2591
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2595 @item show detach-on-fork
2596 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2600 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2601 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2602 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2603 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2604
2605 @table @code
2606 @kindex info forks
2607 @item info forks
2608 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2609 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2610 position (program counter) of the process.
2611
2612 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2613 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2614 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2615 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2616 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2617
2618 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2619 @item process @var{process-id}
2620 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2621 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2622 @samp{info forks}.
2623
2624 @end table
2625
2626 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2627 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2628 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2629 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2633 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2634 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2635 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2636 allowed to run independently.
2637
2638 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2639 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2640 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2641 and remove it from the fork list.
2642
2643 @end table
2644
2645 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2646 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2647 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2648 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2649 the child process's @code{main}.
2650
2651 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2652 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2653
2654 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2655 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2656 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2657 argument.
2658
2659 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2660 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2661 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2662
2663 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2664 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2665
2666 @cindex checkpoint
2667 @cindex restart
2668 @cindex bookmark
2669 @cindex snapshot of a process
2670 @cindex rewind program state
2671
2672 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2673 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2674 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2675 later.
2676
2677 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2678 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2679 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2680 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2681 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2682
2683 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2684 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2685 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2686 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2687 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2688 start again from there.
2689
2690 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2691 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2692
2693 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex checkpoint
2697 @item checkpoint
2698 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2699 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2700 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2701
2702 @kindex info checkpoints
2703 @item info checkpoints
2704 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2705 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2706 listed:
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @item Checkpoint ID
2710 @item Process ID
2711 @item Code Address
2712 @item Source line, or label
2713 @end table
2714
2715 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2716 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2717 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2718 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2719 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2720 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2721 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2722
2723 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2724 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2725 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2726 the debugger.
2727
2728 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2729 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2730 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2731
2732 @end table
2733
2734 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2735 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2736 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2737 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2738 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2739 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2740 previously read data can be read again.
2741
2742 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2743 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2744 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2745 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2746 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2747 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2748
2749 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2750 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2751 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2752 different execution path this time.
2753
2754 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2755 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2756 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2757 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2758 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2759 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2760 potentially pose a problem.
2761
2762 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2763
2764 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2765 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2766 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2767 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2768 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2769 next.
2770
2771 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2772 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2773 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2774 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2775 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2776
2777 @node Stopping
2778 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2779
2780 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2781 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2782 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2783
2784 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2785 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2786 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2787 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2788 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2789 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2790 explicitly request this information at any time.
2791
2792 @table @code
2793 @kindex info program
2794 @item info program
2795 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2796 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @menu
2800 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2801 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2802 * Signals:: Signals
2803 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2804 @end menu
2805
2806 @node Breakpoints
2807 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoints
2810 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2811 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2812 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2813 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2814 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2815 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2816 program.
2817
2818 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2819 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2820 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2821 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2822 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2823 call).
2824
2825 @cindex watchpoints
2826 @cindex data breakpoints
2827 @cindex memory tracing
2828 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2829 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2830 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2831 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2832 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2833 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2834 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2835 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2836 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2837 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2838 same commands.
2839
2840 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2841 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2842 Automatic Display}.
2843
2844 @cindex catchpoints
2845 @cindex breakpoint on events
2846 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2847 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2848 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2849 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2850 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2851 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2852 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2853
2854 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2855 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2856 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2857 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2858 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2859 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2860 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2861 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2862 enable it again.
2863
2864 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2865 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2866 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2867 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2868 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2869 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2870 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2871
2872 @menu
2873 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2874 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2875 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2876 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2877 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2878 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2879 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2880 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2881 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2882 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2883 @end menu
2884
2885 @node Set Breaks
2886 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2887
2888 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2889 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2890 @c
2891 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2892
2893 @kindex break
2894 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2895 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2896 @cindex latest breakpoint
2897 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2898 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2899 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2900 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2901 convenience variables.
2902
2903 @table @code
2904 @item break @var{location}
2905 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2906 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2907 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2908 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2909 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2910
2911 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2912 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2913 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2914
2915 @item break
2916 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2917 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2918 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2919 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2920 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2921 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2922 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2923 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2924 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2925 inside loops.
2926
2927 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2928 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2929 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2930 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2931 existed when your program stopped.
2932
2933 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2934 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2935 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2936 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2937 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2938 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2939 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2940
2941 @kindex tbreak
2942 @item tbreak @var{args}
2943 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2944 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2945 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2946 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2947
2948 @kindex hbreak
2949 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2950 @item hbreak @var{args}
2951 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2952 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2953 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2954 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2955 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2956 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2957 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2958 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2959 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2960 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2961 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2962 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2963 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2964 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2965 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2966 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2967 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2968 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2969
2970 @kindex thbreak
2971 @item thbreak @var{args}
2972 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2973 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2974 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2975 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2976 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2977 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2978 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2979 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2980
2981 @kindex rbreak
2982 @cindex regular expression
2983 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2984 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2985 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2986 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2987 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2988 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2989 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2990 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2991 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2992
2993 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2994 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2995 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2996 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2997 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2998 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2999
3000 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3001 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3002 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3003 classes.
3004
3005 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3006 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3007 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3008
3009 @smallexample
3010 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3011 @end smallexample
3012
3013 @kindex info breakpoints
3014 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3015 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3016 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3017 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3018 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3019 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3020 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3021 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3022
3023 @table @emph
3024 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3025 @item Type
3026 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3027 @item Disposition
3028 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3029 @item Enabled or Disabled
3030 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3031 that are not enabled.
3032 @item Address
3033 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3034 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3035 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3036 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3037 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3038 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3039 @item What
3040 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3041 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3042 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3043 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3044 @end table
3045
3046 @noindent
3047 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3048 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3049 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3050 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3051 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3052 valid location.
3053
3054 @noindent
3055 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3056 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3057 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3058 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3059 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3063 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3064 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3065 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3066 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3067 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3068 @end table
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3071 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3072 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3073 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3074
3075 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3076 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3077
3078 @itemize @bullet
3079
3080 @item
3081 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3082 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3083
3084 @item
3085 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3086 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3087
3088 @item
3089 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3090 several places where that function is inlined.
3091
3092 @end itemize
3093
3094 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3095 the relevant locations.
3096
3097 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3098 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3099 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3100 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3101 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3102 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3103 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3104
3105 For example:
3106
3107 @smallexample
3108 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3109 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3110 stop only if i==1
3111 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3112 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3113 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3114 @end smallexample
3115
3116 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3117 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3118 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3119 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3120 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3121 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3122 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3123 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3124 that belong to that breakpoint.
3125
3126 @cindex pending breakpoints
3127 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3128 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3129 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3130 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3131 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3132 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3133 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3134 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3135 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3136 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3137 is not yet resolved.
3138
3139 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3140 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3141 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3142 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3143 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3144 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3145
3146 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3147 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3148 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3149 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3150
3151 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3152 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3153 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3154
3155 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3156 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3157 address specification to an address:
3158
3159 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3160 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3161 @table @code
3162 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3163 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3164 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3165
3166 @item set breakpoint pending on
3167 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3168 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3169
3170 @item set breakpoint pending off
3171 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3172 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3173 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3174
3175 @item show breakpoint pending
3176 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3177 @end table
3178
3179 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3180 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3181 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3182
3183 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3184 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3185 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3186 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3187 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3188 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3189 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3190 breakpoints.
3191
3192 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3193
3194 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3195 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3196 @table @code
3197 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3198 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3199 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3200 breakpoint must be used.
3201
3202 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3203 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3204 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3205 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3206 @end table
3207
3208
3209 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3210 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3211 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3212 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3213 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3214 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3215 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3216 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3217
3218
3219 @node Set Watchpoints
3220 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3221
3222 @cindex setting watchpoints
3223 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3224 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3225 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3226 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3227 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3228
3229 @itemize @bullet
3230 @item
3231 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3232
3233 @item
3234 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3235 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3236 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3237
3238 @item
3239 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3240 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3241 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3242 @end itemize
3243
3244 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3245 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3246 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3247 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3248 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3249 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3250 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3251 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3252 the expression changes.
3253
3254 @cindex software watchpoints
3255 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3256 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3257 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3258 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3259 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3260 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3261 culprit.)
3262
3263 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3264 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3265 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3266
3267 @table @code
3268 @kindex watch
3269 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3270 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3271 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3272 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3273 to watch the value of a single variable:
3274
3275 @smallexample
3276 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3277 @end smallexample
3278
3279 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3280 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3281 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3282 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3283 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3284 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3285
3286 @kindex rwatch
3287 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3288 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3289 by the program.
3290
3291 @kindex awatch
3292 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3293 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3294 or written into by the program.
3295
3296 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3297 @item info watchpoints
3298 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3299 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3300 @end table
3301
3302 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3303 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3304 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3305 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3306 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3307 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3308
3309 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3310 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3311 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3312 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3313 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3314 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3315 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3316 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3320 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3321 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3322
3323 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3324 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3325 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3326 @end table
3327
3328 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3329 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3330 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3331
3332 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3333
3334 @smallexample
3335 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3336 @end smallexample
3337
3338 @noindent
3339 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3340
3341 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3342 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3343 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3344 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3345 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3346 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3347 will print a message like this:
3348
3349 @smallexample
3350 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3354 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3355 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3356 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3357 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3358 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3359 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3360 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3361
3362 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3363 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3364 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3365 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3366 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3367 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3368
3369 @smallexample
3370 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3371 @end smallexample
3372
3373 @noindent
3374 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3375
3376 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3377 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3378 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3379 expression with separately allocated resources.
3380
3381 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3382 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3383 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3384
3385 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3386 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3387 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3388 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3389 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3390 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3391 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3392 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3393 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3394
3395 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3396 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3397 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3398 watched expression from every thread.
3399
3400 @quotation
3401 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3402 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3403 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3404 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3405 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3406 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3407 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3408 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3409 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3410 @end quotation
3411
3412 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3413
3414 @node Set Catchpoints
3415 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3416 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3417 @cindex exception handlers
3418 @cindex event handling
3419
3420 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3421 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3422 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3423
3424 @table @code
3425 @kindex catch
3426 @item catch @var{event}
3427 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3428 @table @code
3429 @item throw
3430 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3431 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3432
3433 @item catch
3434 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3435
3436 @item exception
3437 @cindex Ada exception catching
3438 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3439 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3440 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3441 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3442 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3443
3444 @item exception unhandled
3445 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3446
3447 @item assert
3448 A failed Ada assertion.
3449
3450 @item exec
3451 @cindex break on fork/exec
3452 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3453 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3454
3455 @item fork
3456 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3457 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3458
3459 @item vfork
3460 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3461 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3462
3463 @item load
3464 @itemx load @var{libname}
3465 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3466 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3467 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3468
3469 @item unload
3470 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3471 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3472 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3473 @end table
3474
3475 @item tcatch @var{event}
3476 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3477 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3478
3479 @end table
3480
3481 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3482
3483 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3484 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3485
3486 @itemize @bullet
3487 @item
3488 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3489 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3490 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3491 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3492 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3493 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3494 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3495 disabled within interactive calls.
3496
3497 @item
3498 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3499
3500 @item
3501 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3502 @end itemize
3503
3504 @cindex raise exceptions
3505 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3506 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3507 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3508 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3509 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3510 out where the exception was raised.
3511
3512 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3513 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3514 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3515 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3519 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3520 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @noindent
3524 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3525 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3526 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3527
3528 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3529 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3530 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3531 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3532 raised.
3533
3534
3535 @node Delete Breaks
3536 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3537
3538 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3539 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3540 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3541 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3542 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3543 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3544
3545 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3546 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3547 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3548 their breakpoint numbers.
3549
3550 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3551 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3552 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3553
3554 @table @code
3555 @kindex clear
3556 @item clear
3557 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3558 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3559 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3560 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3561
3562 @item clear @var{location}
3563 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3564 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3565 most useful ones are listed below:
3566
3567 @table @code
3568 @item clear @var{function}
3569 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3570 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3571
3572 @item clear @var{linenum}
3573 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3574 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3575 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3576 @end table
3577
3578 @cindex delete breakpoints
3579 @kindex delete
3580 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3581 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3582 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3583 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3584 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3585 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3586 @end table
3587
3588 @node Disabling
3589 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3590
3591 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3592 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3593 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3594 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3595 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3596
3597 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3598 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3599 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3600 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3601 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3602
3603 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3604 affects all of its locations.
3605
3606 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3607 states of enablement:
3608
3609 @itemize @bullet
3610 @item
3611 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3612 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3613 @item
3614 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3615 @item
3616 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3617 disabled.
3618 @item
3619 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3620 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3621 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3622 @end itemize
3623
3624 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3625 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3626
3627 @table @code
3628 @kindex disable
3629 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3630 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3631 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3632 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3633 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3634 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3635 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3636
3637 @kindex enable
3638 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3639 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3640 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3641
3642 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3643 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3644 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3645
3646 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3647 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3648 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3649 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3650 @end table
3651
3652 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3653 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3654 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3655 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3656 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3657 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3658 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3659 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3660 Stepping}.)
3661
3662 @node Conditions
3663 @subsection Break Conditions
3664 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3665 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3666
3667 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3668 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3669 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3670 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3671 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3672 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3673 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3674 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3675
3676 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3677 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3678 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3679 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3680 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3681
3682 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3683 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3684 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3685 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3686 one.
3687
3688 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3689 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3690 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3691 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3692 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3693 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3694 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3695 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3696 conditions for the
3697 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3698 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3699
3700 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3701 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3702 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3703 with the @code{condition} command.
3704
3705 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3706 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3707 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3708 catchpoint.
3709
3710 @table @code
3711 @kindex condition
3712 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3713 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3714 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3715 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3716 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3717 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3718 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3719 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3720 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3721 prints an error message:
3722
3723 @smallexample
3724 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3725 @end smallexample
3726
3727 @noindent
3728 @value{GDBN} does
3729 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3730 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3731 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3732
3733 @item condition @var{bnum}
3734 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3735 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3736 @end table
3737
3738 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3739 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3740 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3741 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3742 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3743 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3744 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3745 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3746 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3747 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3748 your program reaches it.
3749
3750 @table @code
3751 @kindex ignore
3752 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3753 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3754 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3755 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3756 takes no action.
3757
3758 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3759 a count of zero.
3760
3761 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3762 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3763 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3764 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3765
3766 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3767 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3768 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3769
3770 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3771 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3772 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3773 Variables}.
3774 @end table
3775
3776 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3777
3778
3779 @node Break Commands
3780 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3781
3782 @cindex breakpoint commands
3783 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3784 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3785 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3786 enable other breakpoints.
3787
3788 @table @code
3789 @kindex commands
3790 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3791 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3792 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3793 @itemx end
3794 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3795 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3796 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3797
3798 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3799 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3800
3801 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3802 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3803 recently encountered).
3804 @end table
3805
3806 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3807 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3808
3809 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3810 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3811 that resumes execution.
3812
3813 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3814 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3815 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3816 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3817 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3818
3819 @kindex silent
3820 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3821 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3822 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3823 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3824 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3825 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3826
3827 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3828 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3829 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3830
3831 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3832 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3833
3834 @smallexample
3835 break foo if x>0
3836 commands
3837 silent
3838 printf "x is %d\n",x
3839 cont
3840 end
3841 @end smallexample
3842
3843 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3844 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3845 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3846 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3847 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3848 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3849 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3850
3851 @smallexample
3852 break 403
3853 commands
3854 silent
3855 set x = y + 4
3856 cont
3857 end
3858 @end smallexample
3859
3860 @node Breakpoint Menus
3861 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3862 @cindex overloading
3863 @cindex symbol overloading
3864
3865 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3866 single function name
3867 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3868 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3869 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3870 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3871 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3872 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3873 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3874 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3875 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3876 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3877 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3878 breakpoints.
3879
3880 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3881 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3882 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3883
3884 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3885 @smallexample
3886 @group
3887 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3888 [0] cancel
3889 [1] all
3890 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3891 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3892 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3893 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3894 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3895 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3896 > 2 4 6
3897 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3898 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3899 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3900 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3901 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3902 breakpoints.
3903 (@value{GDBP})
3904 @end group
3905 @end smallexample
3906
3907 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3908 @node Error in Breakpoints
3909 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3910 @c
3911 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3912 @c
3913 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3914 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3915 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3916 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3917
3918 @smallexample
3919 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3920 The same program may be running in another process.
3921 @end smallexample
3922
3923 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3924
3925 @enumerate
3926 @item
3927 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3928
3929 @item
3930 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3931 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3932 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3933 Then start your program again.
3934
3935 @item
3936 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3937 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3938 to nonsharable executables.
3939 @end enumerate
3940 @c @end ifclear
3941
3942 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3943 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3944
3945 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3946 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3947 @smallexample
3948 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3949 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 @noindent
3953 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3954 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3955 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3956
3957 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3958 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3959
3960 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3961 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3962 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3963
3964 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3965 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3966 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3967 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3968
3969 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3970 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3971 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3972 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3973 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3974 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3975 first in the bundle.
3976
3977 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3978 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3979 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3980 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3981 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3982 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3983 is hit.
3984
3985 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3986 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3987
3988 @smallexample
3989 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3990 @end smallexample
3991
3992 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3993 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3994 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3995 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3996 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3997 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3998 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3999 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4000
4001 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4002 adjusted breakpoints:
4003
4004 @smallexample
4005 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4006 to 0x00010410.
4007 @end smallexample
4008
4009 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4010 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4011 frequently than expected.
4012
4013 @node Continuing and Stepping
4014 @section Continuing and Stepping
4015
4016 @cindex stepping
4017 @cindex continuing
4018 @cindex resuming execution
4019 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4020 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4021 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4022 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4023 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4024 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4025 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4026 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4027
4028 @table @code
4029 @kindex continue
4030 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4031 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4032 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4033 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4034 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4035 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4036 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4037 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4038 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4039 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4040
4041 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4042 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4043 @code{continue} is ignored.
4044
4045 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4046 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4047 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4048 @code{continue}.
4049 @end table
4050
4051 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4052 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4053 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4054 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4055
4056 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4057 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4058 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4059 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4060 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4061 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4062
4063 @table @code
4064 @kindex step
4065 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4066 @item step
4067 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4068 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4069 abbreviated @code{s}.
4070
4071 @quotation
4072 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4073 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4074 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4075 @c distinction here.
4076 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4077 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4078 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4079 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4080 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4081 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4082 below.
4083 @end quotation
4084
4085 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4086 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4087 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4088 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4089 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4090 called within the line.
4091
4092 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4093 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4094 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4095 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4096 was any debugging information about the routine.
4097
4098 @item step @var{count}
4099 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4100 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4101 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4102
4103 @kindex next
4104 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4105 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4106 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4107 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4108 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4109 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4110 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4111 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4112
4113 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4114
4115
4116 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4117 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4118 @c
4119 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4120 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4121 @c function are executed without stopping.
4122
4123 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4124 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4125 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4126
4127 @kindex set step-mode
4128 @item set step-mode
4129 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4130 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4131 @itemx set step-mode on
4132 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4133 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4134 information rather than stepping over it.
4135
4136 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4137 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4138 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4139
4140 @item set step-mode off
4141 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4142 debug information. This is the default.
4143
4144 @item show step-mode
4145 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4146 source line debug information.
4147
4148 @kindex finish
4149 @item finish
4150 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4151 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4152
4153 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4154 ,Returning from a Function}).
4155
4156 @kindex until
4157 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4158 @cindex run until specified location
4159 @item until
4160 @itemx u
4161 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4162 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4163 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4164 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4165 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4166 than the address of the jump.
4167
4168 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4169 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4170 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4171 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4172 through the next iteration.
4173
4174 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4175 stack frame.
4176
4177 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4178 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4179 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4180 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4181 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4182
4183 @smallexample
4184 (@value{GDBP}) f
4185 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4186 206 expand_input();
4187 (@value{GDBP}) until
4188 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4189 @end smallexample
4190
4191 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4192 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4193 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4194 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4195 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4196 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4197 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4198
4199 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4200 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4201 argument.
4202
4203 @item until @var{location}
4204 @itemx u @var{location}
4205 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4206 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4207 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4208 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4209 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4210 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4211 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4212 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4213 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4214 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4215 invocations have returned.
4216
4217 @smallexample
4218 94 int factorial (int value)
4219 95 @{
4220 96 if (value > 1) @{
4221 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4222 98 @}
4223 99 return (value);
4224 100 @}
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227
4228 @kindex advance @var{location}
4229 @itemx advance @var{location}
4230 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4231 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4232 @ref{Specify Location}.
4233 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4234 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4235 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4236 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4237
4238
4239 @kindex stepi
4240 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4241 @item stepi
4242 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4243 @itemx si
4244 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4245
4246 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4247 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4248 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4249 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4250
4251 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4252
4253 @need 750
4254 @kindex nexti
4255 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4256 @item nexti
4257 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4258 @itemx ni
4259 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4260 proceed until the function returns.
4261
4262 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4263 @end table
4264
4265 @node Signals
4266 @section Signals
4267 @cindex signals
4268
4269 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4270 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4271 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4272 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4273 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4274 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4275 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4276 requested an alarm).
4277
4278 @cindex fatal signals
4279 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4280 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4281 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4282 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4283 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4284 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4285
4286 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4287 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4288 signal.
4289
4290 @cindex handling signals
4291 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4292 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4293 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4294 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4295 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4296
4297 @table @code
4298 @kindex info signals
4299 @kindex info handle
4300 @item info signals
4301 @itemx info handle
4302 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4303 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4304 the defined types of signals.
4305
4306 @item info signals @var{sig}
4307 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4308
4309 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4310
4311 @kindex handle
4312 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4313 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4314 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4315 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4316 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4317 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4318 say what change to make.
4319 @end table
4320
4321 @c @group
4322 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4323 Their full names are:
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item nostop
4327 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4328 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4329
4330 @item stop
4331 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4332 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4333
4334 @item print
4335 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4336
4337 @item noprint
4338 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4339 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4340
4341 @item pass
4342 @itemx noignore
4343 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4344 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4345 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4346
4347 @item nopass
4348 @itemx ignore
4349 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4350 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4351 @end table
4352 @c @end group
4353
4354 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4355 program until you
4356 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4357 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4358 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4359 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4360 program sees that signal when you continue.
4361
4362 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4363 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4364 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4365 erroneous signals.
4366
4367 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4368 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4369 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4370 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4371 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4372 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4373 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4374 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4375 Program a Signal}.
4376
4377 @node Thread Stops
4378 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4379
4380 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4381 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4382 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4383
4384 @table @code
4385 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4386 @cindex thread breakpoints
4387 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4388 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4389 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4390 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4391 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4392 specify some source line.
4393
4394 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4395 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4396 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4397 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4398 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4399
4400 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4401 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4402 program.
4403
4404 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4405 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4406 breakpoint condition, like this:
4407
4408 @smallexample
4409 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4410 @end smallexample
4411
4412 @end table
4413
4414 @cindex stopped threads
4415 @cindex threads, stopped
4416 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4417 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4418 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4419 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4420 underfoot.
4421
4422 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4423 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4424 @cindex premature return from system calls
4425 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4426 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4427 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4428 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4429 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4430 stop execution.
4431
4432 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4433 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4434 style anyways.
4435
4436 For example, do not write code like this:
4437
4438 @smallexample
4439 sleep (10);
4440 @end smallexample
4441
4442 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4443 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4444
4445 Instead, write this:
4446
4447 @smallexample
4448 int unslept = 10;
4449 while (unslept > 0)
4450 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4451 @end smallexample
4452
4453 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4454 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4455 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4456 @value{GDBN}.
4457
4458 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4459 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4460 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4461 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4462
4463 @cindex continuing threads
4464 @cindex threads, continuing
4465 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4466 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4467 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4468
4469 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4470 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4471 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4472 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4473 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4474 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4475 stops.
4476
4477 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4478 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4479 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4480 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4481
4482 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4483 thread to run.
4484
4485 @table @code
4486 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4487 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4488 @cindex lock scheduler
4489 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4490 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4491 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4492 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4493 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4494 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4495 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4496 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4497 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4498 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4499 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4500
4501 @item show scheduler-locking
4502 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4503 @end table
4504
4505
4506 @node Stack
4507 @chapter Examining the Stack
4508
4509 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4510 stopped and how it got there.
4511
4512 @cindex call stack
4513 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4514 is generated.
4515 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4516 the arguments of the call,
4517 and the local variables of the function being called.
4518 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4519 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4520 stack}.
4521
4522 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4523 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4524
4525 @cindex selected frame
4526 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4527 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4528 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4529 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4530 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4531 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4532
4533 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4534 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4535 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4536
4537 @menu
4538 * Frames:: Stack frames
4539 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4540 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4541 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4542
4543 @end menu
4544
4545 @node Frames
4546 @section Stack Frames
4547
4548 @cindex frame, definition
4549 @cindex stack frame
4550 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4551 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4552 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4553 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4554 which the function is executing.
4555
4556 @cindex initial frame
4557 @cindex outermost frame
4558 @cindex innermost frame
4559 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4560 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4561 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4562 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4563 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4564 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4565 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4566 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4567
4568 @cindex frame pointer
4569 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4570 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4571 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4572 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4573 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4574 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4575
4576 @cindex frame number
4577 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4578 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4579 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4580 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4581 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4582
4583 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4584 @c underflow problems.
4585 @cindex frameless execution
4586 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4587 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4588 @smallexample
4589 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4590 @end smallexample
4591 generates functions without a frame.)
4592 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4593 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4594 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4595 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4596 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4597 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4598 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4599
4600 @table @code
4601 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4602 @cindex current stack frame
4603 @item frame @var{args}
4604 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4605 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4606 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4607 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4608
4609 @kindex select-frame
4610 @cindex selecting frame silently
4611 @item select-frame
4612 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4613 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4614 @code{frame}.
4615 @end table
4616
4617 @node Backtrace
4618 @section Backtraces
4619
4620 @cindex traceback
4621 @cindex call stack traces
4622 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4623 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4624 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4625 stack.
4626
4627 @table @code
4628 @kindex backtrace
4629 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4630 @item backtrace
4631 @itemx bt
4632 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4633 frames in the stack.
4634
4635 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4636 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4637
4638 @item backtrace @var{n}
4639 @itemx bt @var{n}
4640 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4641
4642 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4643 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4644 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4645
4646 @item backtrace full
4647 @itemx bt full
4648 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4649 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4650 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4651 number of frames to print, as described above.
4652 @end table
4653
4654 @kindex where
4655 @kindex info stack
4656 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4657 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4658
4659 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4660 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4661 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4662 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4663 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4664 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4665 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4666 multi-threaded program.
4667
4668 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4669 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4670 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4671 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4672 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4673 line number.
4674
4675 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4676 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4677
4678 @smallexample
4679 @group
4680 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4681 at builtin.c:993
4682 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4683 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4684 at macro.c:71
4685 (More stack frames follow...)
4686 @end group
4687 @end smallexample
4688
4689 @noindent
4690 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4691 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4692 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4693
4694 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4695 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4696 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4697 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4698 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4699 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4700 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4701 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4702 such a backtrace might look like:
4703
4704 @smallexample
4705 @group
4706 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4707 at builtin.c:993
4708 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4709 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4710 at macro.c:71
4711 (More stack frames follow...)
4712 @end group
4713 @end smallexample
4714
4715 @noindent
4716 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4717 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4718
4719 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4720 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4721 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4722
4723 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4724 @cindex program entry point
4725 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4726 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4727 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4728 @code{main}@footnote{
4729 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4730 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4731 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4732 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4733 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4734 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4735
4736 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4737 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4738
4739 @table @code
4740 @item set backtrace past-main
4741 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4742 @kindex set backtrace
4743 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4744
4745 @item set backtrace past-main off
4746 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4747 default.
4748
4749 @item show backtrace past-main
4750 @kindex show backtrace
4751 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4752
4753 @item set backtrace past-entry
4754 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4755 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4756 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4757 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4758
4759 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4760 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4761 application. This is the default.
4762
4763 @item show backtrace past-entry
4764 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4765
4766 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4767 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4768 @cindex backtrace limit
4769 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4770 unlimited.
4771
4772 @item show backtrace limit
4773 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4774 @end table
4775
4776 @node Selection
4777 @section Selecting a Frame
4778
4779 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4780 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4781 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4782 of the stack frame just selected.
4783
4784 @table @code
4785 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4786 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4787 @item frame @var{n}
4788 @itemx f @var{n}
4789 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4790 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4791 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4792 @code{main}.
4793
4794 @item frame @var{addr}
4795 @itemx f @var{addr}
4796 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4797 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4798 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4799 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4800 switches between them.
4801
4802 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4803 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4804
4805 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4806 pointer and a program counter.
4807
4808 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4809 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4810
4811 @kindex up
4812 @item up @var{n}
4813 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4814 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4815 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4816
4817 @kindex down
4818 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4819 @item down @var{n}
4820 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4821 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4822 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4823 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4824 @end table
4825
4826 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4827 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4828 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4829 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4830
4831 @need 1000
4832 For example:
4833
4834 @smallexample
4835 @group
4836 (@value{GDBP}) up
4837 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4838 at env.c:10
4839 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4840 @end group
4841 @end smallexample
4842
4843 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4844 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4845 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4846 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4847 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4848 for details.
4849
4850 @table @code
4851 @kindex down-silently
4852 @kindex up-silently
4853 @item up-silently @var{n}
4854 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4855 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4856 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4857 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4858 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4859 distracting.
4860 @end table
4861
4862 @node Frame Info
4863 @section Information About a Frame
4864
4865 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4866 stack frame.
4867
4868 @table @code
4869 @item frame
4870 @itemx f
4871 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4872 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4873 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4874 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4875 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4876
4877 @kindex info frame
4878 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4879 @item info frame
4880 @itemx info f
4881 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4882 including:
4883
4884 @itemize @bullet
4885 @item
4886 the address of the frame
4887 @item
4888 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4889 @item
4890 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4891 @item
4892 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4893 @item
4894 the address of the frame's arguments
4895 @item
4896 the address of the frame's local variables
4897 @item
4898 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4899 @item
4900 which registers were saved in the frame
4901 @end itemize
4902
4903 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4904 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4905 the usual conventions.
4906
4907 @item info frame @var{addr}
4908 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4909 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4910 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4911 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4912 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4913 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4914
4915 @kindex info args
4916 @item info args
4917 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4918
4919 @item info locals
4920 @kindex info locals
4921 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4922 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4923 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4924
4925 @kindex info catch
4926 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4927 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4928 @item info catch
4929 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4930 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4931 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4932 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4933 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4934
4935 @end table
4936
4937
4938 @node Source
4939 @chapter Examining Source Files
4940
4941 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4942 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4943 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4944 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4945 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4946 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4947 source files by explicit command.
4948
4949 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4950 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4951 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4952
4953 @menu
4954 * List:: Printing source lines
4955 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4956 * Edit:: Editing source files
4957 * Search:: Searching source files
4958 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4959 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4960 @end menu
4961
4962 @node List
4963 @section Printing Source Lines
4964
4965 @kindex list
4966 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4967 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4968 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4969 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4970 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4971
4972 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4973
4974 @table @code
4975 @item list @var{linenum}
4976 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4977 current source file.
4978
4979 @item list @var{function}
4980 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4981 @var{function}.
4982
4983 @item list
4984 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4985 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4986 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4987 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4988 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4989
4990 @item list -
4991 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4992 @end table
4993
4994 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4995 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4996 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4997
4998 @table @code
4999 @kindex set listsize
5000 @item set listsize @var{count}
5001 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5002 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5003
5004 @kindex show listsize
5005 @item show listsize
5006 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5007 @end table
5008
5009 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5010 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5011 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5012 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5013 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5014
5015 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5016 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5017 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5018 to specify some source line.
5019
5020 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5021
5022 @table @code
5023 @item list @var{linespec}
5024 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5025
5026 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5027 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5028 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5029 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5030 the same source file as the first linespec.
5031
5032 @item list ,@var{last}
5033 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5034
5035 @item list @var{first},
5036 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5037
5038 @item list +
5039 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5040
5041 @item list -
5042 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5043
5044 @item list
5045 As described in the preceding table.
5046 @end table
5047
5048 @node Specify Location
5049 @section Specifying a Location
5050 @cindex specifying location
5051 @cindex linespec
5052
5053 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5054 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5055 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5056 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5057
5058 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5059 @value{GDBN} understands:
5060
5061 @table @code
5062 @item @var{linenum}
5063 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5064
5065 @item -@var{offset}
5066 @itemx +@var{offset}
5067 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5068 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5069 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5070 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5071 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5072 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5073 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5074 linespec.
5075
5076 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5077 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5078
5079 @item @var{function}
5080 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5081 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5082
5083 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5084 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5085 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5086 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5087 functions in different source files.
5088
5089 @item *@var{address}
5090 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5091 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5092 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5093 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5094 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5095 source files.
5096
5097 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5098 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5099 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5100 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5101 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5102 of @var{address}:
5103
5104 @table @code
5105 @item @var{expression}
5106 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5107
5108 @item @var{funcaddr}
5109 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5110 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5111 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5112 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5113 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5114 (although the Pascal form also works).
5115
5116 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5117 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5118
5119 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5120 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5121 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5122 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5123 functions with identical names in different source files.
5124 @end table
5125
5126 @end table
5127
5128
5129 @node Edit
5130 @section Editing Source Files
5131 @cindex editing source files
5132
5133 @kindex edit
5134 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5135 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5136 The editing program of your choice
5137 is invoked with the current line set to
5138 the active line in the program.
5139 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5140 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5141
5142 @table @code
5143 @item edit @var{location}
5144 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5145 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5146 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5147 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5148 command most commonly used:
5149
5150 @table @code
5151 @item edit @var{number}
5152 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5153
5154 @item edit @var{function}
5155 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5156 @end table
5157
5158 @end table
5159
5160 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5161 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5162 @footnote{
5163 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5164 following command-line syntax:
5165 @smallexample
5166 ex +@var{number} file
5167 @end smallexample
5168 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5169 the file where to start editing.}.
5170 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5171 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5172 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5173 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5174 @smallexample
5175 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5176 export EDITOR
5177 gdb @dots{}
5178 @end smallexample
5179 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5180 @smallexample
5181 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5182 gdb @dots{}
5183 @end smallexample
5184
5185 @node Search
5186 @section Searching Source Files
5187 @cindex searching source files
5188
5189 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5190 regular expression.
5191
5192 @table @code
5193 @kindex search
5194 @kindex forward-search
5195 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5196 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5197 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5198 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5199 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5200 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5201 @code{fo}.
5202
5203 @kindex reverse-search
5204 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5205 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5206 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5207 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5208 this command as @code{rev}.
5209 @end table
5210
5211 @node Source Path
5212 @section Specifying Source Directories
5213
5214 @cindex source path
5215 @cindex directories for source files
5216 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5217 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5218 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5219 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5220 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5221 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5222 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5223
5224 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5225 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5226 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5227 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5228 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5229 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5230 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5231 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5232 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5233 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5234 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5235
5236 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5237 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5238 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5239 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5240 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5241 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5242
5243 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5244 source files.
5245
5246 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5247 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5248 each line is in the file.
5249
5250 @kindex directory
5251 @kindex dir
5252 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5253 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5254 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5255
5256 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5257 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5258
5259 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5260 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5261 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5262 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5263 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5264 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5265 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5266 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5267 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5268 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5269 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5270 name to look up the sources.
5271
5272 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5273 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5274 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5275 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5276 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5277 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5278 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5279 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5280
5281 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5282 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5283 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5284 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5285 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5286 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5287 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5288
5289 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5290 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5291 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5292 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5293 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5294 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5295 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5296 command.
5297
5298 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5299 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5300 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5301 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5302 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5303 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5304 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5308 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5309 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5310 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5311 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5312 part of absolute file names) or
5313 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5314 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5315
5316 @kindex cdir
5317 @kindex cwd
5318 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5319 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5320 @cindex compilation directory
5321 @cindex current directory
5322 @cindex working directory
5323 @cindex directory, current
5324 @cindex directory, compilation
5325 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5326 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5327 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5328 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5329 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5330 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5331
5332 @item directory
5333 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5334
5335 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5336 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5337
5338 @item show directories
5339 @kindex show directories
5340 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5341
5342 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5343 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5344 @kindex set substitute-path
5345 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5346 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5347 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5348
5349 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5350 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5351
5352 @smallexample
5353 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5354 @end smallexample
5355
5356 @noindent
5357 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5358 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5359 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5360
5361 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5362 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5363 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5364 the substitution.
5365
5366 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5367
5368 @smallexample
5369 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5370 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5371 @end smallexample
5372
5373 @noindent
5374 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5375 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5376 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5377 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5378
5379
5380 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5381 @kindex unset substitute-path
5382 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5383 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5384 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5385
5386 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5387
5388 @item show substitute-path [path]
5389 @kindex show substitute-path
5390 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5391 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5392
5393 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5394 rules.
5395
5396 @end table
5397
5398 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5399 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5400 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5401
5402 @enumerate
5403 @item
5404 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5405
5406 @item
5407 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5408 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5409 directories in one command.
5410 @end enumerate
5411
5412 @node Machine Code
5413 @section Source and Machine Code
5414 @cindex source line and its code address
5415
5416 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5417 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5418 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5419 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5420 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5421 well as hex.
5422
5423 @table @code
5424 @kindex info line
5425 @item info line @var{linespec}
5426 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5427 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5428 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5429 @end table
5430
5431 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5432 the object code for the first line of function
5433 @code{m4_changequote}:
5434
5435 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5436 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5437 @smallexample
5438 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5439 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5440 @end smallexample
5441
5442 @noindent
5443 @cindex code address and its source line
5444 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5445 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5446 @smallexample
5447 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5448 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5449 @end smallexample
5450
5451 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5452 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5453 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5454 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5455 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5456 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5457 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5458 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5459 Variables}).
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex disassemble
5463 @cindex assembly instructions
5464 @cindex instructions, assembly
5465 @cindex machine instructions
5466 @cindex listing machine instructions
5467 @item disassemble
5468 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5469 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5470 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5471 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5472 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5473 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5474 @end table
5475
5476 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5477 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5478
5479 @smallexample
5480 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5481 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5482 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5483 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5484 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5485 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5486 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5487 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5488 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5489 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5490 End of assembler dump.
5491 @end smallexample
5492
5493 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5494 mnemonics or other syntax.
5495
5496 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5497 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5498 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5499 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5500 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5501
5502 @table @code
5503 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5504 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5505 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5506 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5507 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5508 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5509
5510 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5511 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5512 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5513 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5514
5515 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5516 @item show disassembly-flavor
5517 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5518 @end table
5519
5520
5521 @node Data
5522 @chapter Examining Data
5523
5524 @cindex printing data
5525 @cindex examining data
5526 @kindex print
5527 @kindex inspect
5528 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5529 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5530 @c different window or something like that.
5531 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5532 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5533 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5534 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5535 Different Languages}).
5536
5537 @table @code
5538 @item print @var{expr}
5539 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5540 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5541 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5542 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5543 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5544 Formats}.
5545
5546 @item print
5547 @itemx print /@var{f}
5548 @cindex reprint the last value
5549 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5550 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5551 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5552 @end table
5553
5554 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5555 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5556 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5557
5558 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5559 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5560 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5561 Table}.
5562
5563 @menu
5564 * Expressions:: Expressions
5565 * Variables:: Program variables
5566 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5567 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5568 * Memory:: Examining memory
5569 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5570 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5571 * Value History:: Value history
5572 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5573 * Registers:: Registers
5574 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5575 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5576 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5577 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5578 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5579 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5580 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5581 character set than GDB does
5582 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5583 @end menu
5584
5585 @node Expressions
5586 @section Expressions
5587
5588 @cindex expressions
5589 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5590 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5591 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5592 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5593 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5594 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5595 @ref{Compilation}.
5596
5597 @cindex arrays in expressions
5598 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5599 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5600 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5601 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5602 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5603 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5604
5605 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5606 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5607 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5608 languages.
5609
5610 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5611 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5612
5613 @cindex casts, in expressions
5614 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5615 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5616 at that address in memory.
5617 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5618
5619 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5620 to programming languages:
5621
5622 @table @code
5623 @item @@
5624 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5625 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5626
5627 @item ::
5628 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5629 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5630
5631 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5632 @cindex type casting memory
5633 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5634 @cindex casts, to view memory
5635 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5636 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5637 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5638 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5639 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5640 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5641 @end table
5642
5643 @node Variables
5644 @section Program Variables
5645
5646 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5647 in your program.
5648
5649 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5650 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5651
5652 @itemize @bullet
5653 @item
5654 global (or file-static)
5655 @end itemize
5656
5657 @noindent or
5658
5659 @itemize @bullet
5660 @item
5661 visible according to the scope rules of the
5662 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5663 @end itemize
5664
5665 @noindent This means that in the function
5666
5667 @smallexample
5668 foo (a)
5669 int a;
5670 @{
5671 bar (a);
5672 @{
5673 int b = test ();
5674 bar (b);
5675 @}
5676 @}
5677 @end smallexample
5678
5679 @noindent
5680 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5681 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5682 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5683 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5684
5685 @cindex variable name conflict
5686 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5687 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5688 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5689 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5690 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5691 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5692 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5693
5694 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5695 @ifnotinfo
5696 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5697 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5698 @end ifnotinfo
5699 @smallexample
5700 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5701 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5702 @end smallexample
5703
5704 @noindent
5705 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5706 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5707 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5708 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5709
5710 @smallexample
5711 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5712 @end smallexample
5713
5714 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5715 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5716 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5717 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5718 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5719 @c conflict?? --mew
5720
5721 @cindex wrong values
5722 @cindex variable values, wrong
5723 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5724 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5725 @quotation
5726 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5727 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5728 scope, and just before exit.
5729 @end quotation
5730 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5731 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5732 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5733 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5734 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5735 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5736 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5737 variable definitions may be gone.
5738
5739 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5740 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5741 when compiling.
5742
5743 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5744 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5745 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5746 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5747 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5748 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5749 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5753 @end smallexample
5754
5755 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5756 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5757 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5758 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5759 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5760 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5761 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5762 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5763 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5764 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5765 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5766
5767 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5768 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5769 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5770 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5771
5772 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5773 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5774 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5775 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5776 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5777 For program code
5778
5779 @smallexample
5780 char var0[] = "A";
5781 signed char var1[] = "A";
5782 @end smallexample
5783
5784 You get during debugging
5785 @smallexample
5786 (gdb) print var0
5787 $1 = "A"
5788 (gdb) print var1
5789 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5790 @end smallexample
5791
5792 @node Arrays
5793 @section Artificial Arrays
5794
5795 @cindex artificial array
5796 @cindex arrays
5797 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5798 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5799 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5800 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5801 program.
5802
5803 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5804 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5805 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5806 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5807 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5808 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5809 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5810 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5811 example. If a program says
5812
5813 @smallexample
5814 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5815 @end smallexample
5816
5817 @noindent
5818 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5819
5820 @smallexample
5821 p *array@@len
5822 @end smallexample
5823
5824 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5825 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5826 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5827 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5828 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5829
5830 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5831 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5832 The value need not be in memory:
5833 @smallexample
5834 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5835 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5836 @end smallexample
5837
5838 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5839 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5840 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5841 @smallexample
5842 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5843 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5844 @end smallexample
5845
5846 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5847 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5848 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5849 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5850 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5851 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5852 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5853 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5854 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5855 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5856
5857 @smallexample
5858 set $i = 0
5859 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5860 @key{RET}
5861 @key{RET}
5862 @dots{}
5863 @end smallexample
5864
5865 @node Output Formats
5866 @section Output Formats
5867
5868 @cindex formatted output
5869 @cindex output formats
5870 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5871 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5872 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5873 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5874 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5875
5876 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5877 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5878 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5879 letters supported are:
5880
5881 @table @code
5882 @item x
5883 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5884 hexadecimal.
5885
5886 @item d
5887 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5888
5889 @item u
5890 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5891
5892 @item o
5893 Print as integer in octal.
5894
5895 @item t
5896 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5897 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5898 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5899 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5900
5901 @item a
5902 @cindex unknown address, locating
5903 @cindex locate address
5904 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5905 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5906 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5907
5908 @smallexample
5909 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5910 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5911 @end smallexample
5912
5913 @noindent
5914 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5915 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5916
5917 @item c
5918 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5919 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5920 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5921 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5922
5923 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5924 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5925 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5926 data.
5927
5928 @item f
5929 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5930 using typical floating point syntax.
5931
5932 @item s
5933 @cindex printing strings
5934 @cindex printing byte arrays
5935 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5936 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5937 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5938 natural types.
5939
5940 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5941 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5942 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5943 array.
5944 @end table
5945
5946 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5947
5948 @smallexample
5949 p/x $pc
5950 @end smallexample
5951
5952 @noindent
5953 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5954 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5955
5956 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5957 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5958 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5959
5960 @node Memory
5961 @section Examining Memory
5962
5963 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5964 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5965
5966 @cindex examining memory
5967 @table @code
5968 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5969 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5970 @itemx x @var{addr}
5971 @itemx x
5972 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5973 @end table
5974
5975 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5976 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5977 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5978 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5979 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5980
5981 @table @r
5982 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5983 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5984 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5985 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5986 @c 4.1.2.
5987
5988 @item @var{f}, the display format
5989 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5990 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5991 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5992 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5993 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5994
5995 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5996 The unit size is any of
5997
5998 @table @code
5999 @item b
6000 Bytes.
6001 @item h
6002 Halfwords (two bytes).
6003 @item w
6004 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6005 @item g
6006 Giant words (eight bytes).
6007 @end table
6008
6009 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6010 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6011 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6012
6013 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6014 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6015 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6016 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6017 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6018 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6019 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6020 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6021 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6022 a value from memory).
6023 @end table
6024
6025 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6026 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6027 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6028 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6029 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6030
6031 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6032 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6033 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6034 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6035 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6036
6037 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6038 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6039 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6040 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6041 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6042 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6043 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6044 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6045 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6046
6047 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6048 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6049 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6050 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6051 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6052 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6053 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6054
6055 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6056 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6057 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6058 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6059 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6060 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6061 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6062 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6063 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6064
6065 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6066 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6067 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6068
6069 @cindex remote memory comparison
6070 @cindex verify remote memory image
6071 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6072 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6073 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6074 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6075 situations.
6076
6077 @table @code
6078 @kindex compare-sections
6079 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6080 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6081 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6082 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6083 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6084 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6085 remote request.
6086 @end table
6087
6088 @node Auto Display
6089 @section Automatic Display
6090 @cindex automatic display
6091 @cindex display of expressions
6092
6093 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6094 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6095 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6096 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6097 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6098 The automatic display looks like this:
6099
6100 @smallexample
6101 2: foo = 38
6102 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6103 @end smallexample
6104
6105 @noindent
6106 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6107 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6108 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6109 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6110 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6111 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6112
6113 @table @code
6114 @kindex display
6115 @item display @var{expr}
6116 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6117 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6118
6119 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6120
6121 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6122 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6123 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6124 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6125 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6126
6127 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6128 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6129 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6130 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6131 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6132 @end table
6133
6134 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6135 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6136 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6137
6138 @table @code
6139 @kindex delete display
6140 @kindex undisplay
6141 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6142 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6143 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6144
6145 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6146 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6147
6148 @kindex disable display
6149 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6150 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6151 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6152 enabled again later.
6153
6154 @kindex enable display
6155 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6156 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6157 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6158
6159 @item display
6160 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6161 done when your program stops.
6162
6163 @kindex info display
6164 @item info display
6165 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6166 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6167 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6168 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6169 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6170 @end table
6171
6172 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6173 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6174 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6175 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6176 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6177 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6178 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6179 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6180 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6181 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6182 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6183
6184 @node Print Settings
6185 @section Print Settings
6186
6187 @cindex format options
6188 @cindex print settings
6189 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6190 and symbols are printed.
6191
6192 @noindent
6193 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6194
6195 @table @code
6196 @kindex set print
6197 @item set print address
6198 @itemx set print address on
6199 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6200 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6201 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6202 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6203 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6204 @code{set print address on}:
6205
6206 @smallexample
6207 @group
6208 (@value{GDBP}) f
6209 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6210 at input.c:530
6211 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6212 @end group
6213 @end smallexample
6214
6215 @item set print address off
6216 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6217 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6218
6219 @smallexample
6220 @group
6221 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6222 (@value{GDBP}) f
6223 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6224 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6225 @end group
6226 @end smallexample
6227
6228 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6229 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6230 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6231 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6232
6233 @kindex show print
6234 @item show print address
6235 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6236 @end table
6237
6238 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6239 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6240 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6241 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6242 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6243 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6244 it prints a symbolic address:
6245
6246 @table @code
6247 @item set print symbol-filename on
6248 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6249 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6250 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6251 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6252
6253 @item set print symbol-filename off
6254 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6255 default.
6256
6257 @item show print symbol-filename
6258 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6259 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6260 @end table
6261
6262 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6263 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6264 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6265
6266 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6267 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6268
6269 @table @code
6270 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6271 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6272 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6273 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6274 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6275 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6276
6277 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6278 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6279 symbolic address.
6280 @end table
6281
6282 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6283 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6284 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6285 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6286 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6287 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6288 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6289 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6290
6291 @smallexample
6292 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6293 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6294 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6295 @end smallexample
6296
6297 @quotation
6298 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6299 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6300 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6301 @end quotation
6302
6303 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6304
6305 @table @code
6306 @item set print array
6307 @itemx set print array on
6308 @cindex pretty print arrays
6309 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6310 but uses more space. The default is off.
6311
6312 @item set print array off
6313 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6314
6315 @item show print array
6316 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6317 arrays.
6318
6319 @cindex print array indexes
6320 @item set print array-indexes
6321 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6322 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6323 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6324 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6325
6326 @item set print array-indexes off
6327 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6328
6329 @item show print array-indexes
6330 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6331 arrays.
6332
6333 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6334 @cindex number of array elements to print
6335 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6336 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6337 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6338 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6339 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6340 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6341 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6342
6343 @item show print elements
6344 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6345 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6346
6347 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6348 @cindex printing frame argument values
6349 @cindex print all frame argument values
6350 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6351 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6352 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6353 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6354 values are:
6355
6356 @table @code
6357 @item all
6358 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6359
6360 @item scalars
6361 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6362 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6363 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6364
6365 @smallexample
6366 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6367 at frame-args.c:23
6368 @end smallexample
6369
6370 @item none
6371 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6372 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6373
6374 @smallexample
6375 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6376 at frame-args.c:23
6377 @end smallexample
6378 @end table
6379
6380 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6381 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6382 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6383 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6384 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6385 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6386 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6387 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6388
6389 @item show print frame-arguments
6390 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6391
6392 @item set print repeats
6393 @cindex repeated array elements
6394 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6395 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6396 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6397 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6398 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6399 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6400 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6401
6402 @item show print repeats
6403 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6404 elements.
6405
6406 @item set print null-stop
6407 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6408 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6409 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6410 contain only short strings.
6411 The default is off.
6412
6413 @item show print null-stop
6414 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6415 @sc{null} character.
6416
6417 @item set print pretty on
6418 @cindex print structures in indented form
6419 @cindex indentation in structure display
6420 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6421 per line, like this:
6422
6423 @smallexample
6424 @group
6425 $1 = @{
6426 next = 0x0,
6427 flags = @{
6428 sweet = 1,
6429 sour = 1
6430 @},
6431 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6432 @}
6433 @end group
6434 @end smallexample
6435
6436 @item set print pretty off
6437 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6438
6439 @smallexample
6440 @group
6441 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6442 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6443 @end group
6444 @end smallexample
6445
6446 @noindent
6447 This is the default format.
6448
6449 @item show print pretty
6450 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6451
6452 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6453 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6454 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6455 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6456 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6457 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6458 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6459 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6460
6461 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6462 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6463 international character sets, and is the default.
6464
6465 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6466 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6467
6468 @item set print union on
6469 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6470 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6471 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6472
6473 @item set print union off
6474 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6475 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6476 instead.
6477
6478 @item show print union
6479 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6480 structures and other unions.
6481
6482 For example, given the declarations
6483
6484 @smallexample
6485 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6486 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6487 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6488 Bug_forms;
6489
6490 struct thing @{
6491 Species it;
6492 union @{
6493 Tree_forms tree;
6494 Bug_forms bug;
6495 @} form;
6496 @};
6497
6498 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 @noindent
6502 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6506 @end smallexample
6507
6508 @noindent
6509 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6510
6511 @smallexample
6512 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6513 @end smallexample
6514
6515 @noindent
6516 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6517 and in Pascal.
6518 @end table
6519
6520 @need 1000
6521 @noindent
6522 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6523
6524 @table @code
6525 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6526 @item set print demangle
6527 @itemx set print demangle on
6528 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6529 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6530 linkage. The default is on.
6531
6532 @item show print demangle
6533 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6534
6535 @item set print asm-demangle
6536 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6537 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6538 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6539 The default is off.
6540
6541 @item show print asm-demangle
6542 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6543 or demangled form.
6544
6545 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6546 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6547 @kindex set demangle-style
6548 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6549 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6550 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6551
6552 @table @code
6553 @item auto
6554 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6555
6556 @item gnu
6557 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6558 This is the default.
6559
6560 @item hp
6561 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6562
6563 @item lucid
6564 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6565
6566 @item arm
6567 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6568 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6569 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6570 require further enhancement to permit that.
6571
6572 @end table
6573 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6574
6575 @item show demangle-style
6576 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6577
6578 @item set print object
6579 @itemx set print object on
6580 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6581 @cindex display derived types
6582 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6583 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6584 the virtual function table.
6585
6586 @item set print object off
6587 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6588 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6589
6590 @item show print object
6591 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6592
6593 @item set print static-members
6594 @itemx set print static-members on
6595 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6596 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6597
6598 @item set print static-members off
6599 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6600
6601 @item show print static-members
6602 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6603
6604 @item set print pascal_static-members
6605 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6606 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6607 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6608 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6609
6610 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6611 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6612
6613 @item show print pascal_static-members
6614 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6615
6616 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6617 @item set print vtbl
6618 @itemx set print vtbl on
6619 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6620 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6621 @cindex VTBL display
6622 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6623 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6624 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6625
6626 @item set print vtbl off
6627 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6628
6629 @item show print vtbl
6630 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6631 @end table
6632
6633 @node Value History
6634 @section Value History
6635
6636 @cindex value history
6637 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6638 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6639 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6640 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6641 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6642 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6643 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6644 symbol table.
6645
6646 @cindex @code{$}
6647 @cindex @code{$$}
6648 @cindex history number
6649 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6650 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6651 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6652 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6653 history number.
6654
6655 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6656 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6657 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6658 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6659 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6660 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6661 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6662
6663 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6664 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6665
6666 @smallexample
6667 p *$
6668 @end smallexample
6669
6670 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6671 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6672
6673 @smallexample
6674 p *$.next
6675 @end smallexample
6676
6677 @noindent
6678 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6679 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6680
6681 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6682 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6683
6684 @smallexample
6685 print x
6686 set x=5
6687 @end smallexample
6688
6689 @noindent
6690 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6691 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6692
6693 @table @code
6694 @kindex show values
6695 @item show values
6696 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6697 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6698 values} does not change the history.
6699
6700 @item show values @var{n}
6701 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6702
6703 @item show values +
6704 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6705 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6706 @end table
6707
6708 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6709 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6710
6711 @node Convenience Vars
6712 @section Convenience Variables
6713
6714 @cindex convenience variables
6715 @cindex user-defined variables
6716 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6717 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6718 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6719 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6720 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6721
6722 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6723 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6724 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6725 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6726 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6727
6728 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6729 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6730 For example:
6731
6732 @smallexample
6733 set $foo = *object_ptr
6734 @end smallexample
6735
6736 @noindent
6737 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6738 @code{object_ptr}.
6739
6740 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6741 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6742 value with another assignment at any time.
6743
6744 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6745 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6746 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6747 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6748
6749 @table @code
6750 @kindex show convenience
6751 @cindex show all user variables
6752 @item show convenience
6753 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6754 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6755
6756 @kindex init-if-undefined
6757 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6758 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6759 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6760 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6761 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6762 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6763 override default values used in a command script.
6764
6765 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6766 any side-effects do not occur.
6767 @end table
6768
6769 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6770 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6771 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6772
6773 @smallexample
6774 set $i = 0
6775 print bar[$i++]->contents
6776 @end smallexample
6777
6778 @noindent
6779 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6780
6781 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6782 values likely to be useful.
6783
6784 @table @code
6785 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6786 @item $_
6787 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6788 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6789 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6790 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6791 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6792 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6793 to the type of @code{$__}.
6794
6795 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6796 @item $__
6797 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6798 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6799 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6800
6801 @item $_exitcode
6802 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6803 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6804 the program being debugged terminates.
6805 @end table
6806
6807 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6808 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6809 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6810
6811 @node Registers
6812 @section Registers
6813
6814 @cindex registers
6815 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6816 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6817 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6818 your machine.
6819
6820 @table @code
6821 @kindex info registers
6822 @item info registers
6823 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6824 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6825
6826 @kindex info all-registers
6827 @cindex floating point registers
6828 @item info all-registers
6829 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6830 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6831
6832 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6833 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6834 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6835 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6836 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6837 @end table
6838
6839 @cindex stack pointer register
6840 @cindex program counter register
6841 @cindex process status register
6842 @cindex frame pointer register
6843 @cindex standard registers
6844 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6845 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6846 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6847 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6848 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6849 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6850 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6851 you could print the program counter in hex with
6852
6853 @smallexample
6854 p/x $pc
6855 @end smallexample
6856
6857 @noindent
6858 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6859
6860 @smallexample
6861 x/i $pc
6862 @end smallexample
6863
6864 @noindent
6865 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6866 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6867 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6868 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6869 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6870 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6871 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6872
6873 @smallexample
6874 set $sp += 4
6875 @end smallexample
6876
6877 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6878 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6879 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6880 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6881 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6882 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6883 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6884
6885 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6886 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6887 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6888 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6889 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6890 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6891 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6892
6893 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6894 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6895 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6896 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6897 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6898 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6899 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6900 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6901 prints the data in both formats.
6902
6903 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6904 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6905 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6906 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6907 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6908 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6909 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6910
6911 @smallexample
6912 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6913 $1 = @{
6914 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6915 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6916 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6917 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6918 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6919 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6920 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6921 @}
6922 @end smallexample
6923
6924 @noindent
6925 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6926 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6927 value to a @code{struct} member:
6928
6929 @smallexample
6930 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6931 @end smallexample
6932
6933 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6934 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6935 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6936 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6937 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6938 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6939
6940 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6941 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6942 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6943 frame makes no difference.
6944
6945 @node Floating Point Hardware
6946 @section Floating Point Hardware
6947 @cindex floating point
6948
6949 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6950 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6951
6952 @table @code
6953 @kindex info float
6954 @item info float
6955 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6956 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6957 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6958 the ARM and x86 machines.
6959 @end table
6960
6961 @node Vector Unit
6962 @section Vector Unit
6963 @cindex vector unit
6964
6965 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6966 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6967
6968 @table @code
6969 @kindex info vector
6970 @item info vector
6971 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6972 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6973 @end table
6974
6975 @node OS Information
6976 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6977 @cindex OS information
6978
6979 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6980 you debug your program.
6981
6982 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6983 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6984 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6985 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6986 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6987 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6988 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6989 structure.
6990
6991 @table @code
6992 @item info udot
6993 @kindex info udot
6994 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6995 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6996 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6997 the @code{examine} command.
6998 @end table
6999
7000 @cindex auxiliary vector
7001 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7002 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7003 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7004 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7005 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7006 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7007 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7008 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7009 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7010 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7011 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7012 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7013
7014 @table @code
7015 @kindex info auxv
7016 @item info auxv
7017 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7018 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7019 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7020 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7021 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7022 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7023 an unrecognized tag.
7024 @end table
7025
7026
7027 @node Memory Region Attributes
7028 @section Memory Region Attributes
7029 @cindex memory region attributes
7030
7031 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7032 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7033 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7034 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7035 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7036 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7037 user can override the fetched regions.
7038
7039 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7040 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7041 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7042 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7043 all memory.
7044
7045 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7046 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7047
7048 @table @code
7049 @kindex mem
7050 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7051 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7052 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7053 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7054 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7055 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7056
7057 @item mem auto
7058 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7059 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7060
7061 @kindex delete mem
7062 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7063 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7064 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7065
7066 @kindex disable mem
7067 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7068 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7069 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7070 It may be enabled again later.
7071
7072 @kindex enable mem
7073 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7074 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7075
7076 @kindex info mem
7077 @item info mem
7078 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7079 for each region:
7080
7081 @table @emph
7082 @item Memory Region Number
7083 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7084 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7085 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7086
7087 @item Lo Address
7088 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7089
7090 @item Hi Address
7091 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7092
7093 @item Attributes
7094 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7095 @end table
7096 @end table
7097
7098
7099 @subsection Attributes
7100
7101 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7102 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7103 write accesses to a memory region.
7104
7105 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7106 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7107 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7108
7109 @table @code
7110 @item ro
7111 Memory is read only.
7112 @item wo
7113 Memory is write only.
7114 @item rw
7115 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7116 @end table
7117
7118 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7119 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7120 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7121 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7122 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7123
7124 @table @code
7125 @item 8
7126 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7127 @item 16
7128 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7129 @item 32
7130 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7131 @item 64
7132 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7133 @end table
7134
7135 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7136 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7137 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7138 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7139 @c
7140 @c @table @code
7141 @c @item hwbreak
7142 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7143 @c @item swbreak (default)
7144 @c @end table
7145
7146 @subsubsection Data Cache
7147 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7148 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7149 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7150 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7151 registers.
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item cache
7155 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7156 @item nocache
7157 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7158 @end table
7159
7160 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7161 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7162 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7163 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7164 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7165
7166 @table @code
7167 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7168 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7169 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7170 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7171 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7172 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7173 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7174 The default value is @code{on}.
7175 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7176 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7177 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7178 @end table
7179
7180
7181 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7182 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7183 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7184 @c
7185 @c @table @code
7186 @c @item verify
7187 @c @item noverify (default)
7188 @c @end table
7189
7190 @node Dump/Restore Files
7191 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7192 @cindex dump/restore files
7193 @cindex append data to a file
7194 @cindex dump data to a file
7195 @cindex restore data from a file
7196
7197 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7198 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7199 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7200 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7201 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7202 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7203 files.
7204
7205 @table @code
7206
7207 @kindex dump
7208 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7209 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7210 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7211 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7212
7213 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7214 @table @code
7215 @item binary
7216 Raw binary form.
7217 @item ihex
7218 Intel hex format.
7219 @item srec
7220 Motorola S-record format.
7221 @item tekhex
7222 Tektronix Hex format.
7223 @end table
7224
7225 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7226 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7227 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7228 form.
7229
7230 @kindex append
7231 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7232 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7233 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7234 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7235 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7236
7237 @kindex restore
7238 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7239 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7240 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7241 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7242 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7243
7244 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7245 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7246 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7247 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7248 from that location.
7249
7250 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7251 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7252 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7253 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7254
7255 @end table
7256
7257 @node Core File Generation
7258 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7259 @cindex dump core from inferior
7260
7261 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7262 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7263 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7264 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7265 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7266 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7267 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7268
7269 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7270 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7271 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7272
7273 @table @code
7274 @kindex gcore
7275 @kindex generate-core-file
7276 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7277 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7278 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7279 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7280 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7281 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7282
7283 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7284 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7285 @end table
7286
7287 @node Character Sets
7288 @section Character Sets
7289 @cindex character sets
7290 @cindex charset
7291 @cindex translating between character sets
7292 @cindex host character set
7293 @cindex target character set
7294
7295 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7296 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7297 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7298 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7299 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7300 @dfn{target character set}.
7301
7302 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7303 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7304 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7305 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7306 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7307 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7308 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7309 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7310 character and string literals in expressions.
7311
7312 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7313 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7314 target-charset} command, described below.
7315
7316 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7317 support:
7318
7319 @table @code
7320 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7321 @kindex set target-charset
7322 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7323 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7324 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7325 list the target character sets it supports.
7326 @end table
7327
7328 @table @code
7329 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7330 @kindex set host-charset
7331 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7332
7333 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7334 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7335 @code{set host-charset} command.
7336
7337 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7338 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7339 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7340 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7341 list the host character sets it supports.
7342
7343 @item set charset @var{charset}
7344 @kindex set charset
7345 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7346 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7347 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7348 for both host and target.
7349
7350
7351 @item show charset
7352 @kindex show charset
7353 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7354
7355 @itemx show host-charset
7356 @kindex show host-charset
7357 Show the name of the current host charset.
7358
7359 @itemx show target-charset
7360 @kindex show target-charset
7361 Show the name of the current target charset.
7362
7363 @end table
7364
7365 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7366 sets:
7367
7368 @table @code
7369
7370 @item ASCII
7371 @cindex ASCII character set
7372 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7373 character set.
7374
7375 @item ISO-8859-1
7376 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7377 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7378 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7379 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7380 this as its host character set.
7381
7382 @item EBCDIC-US
7383 @itemx IBM1047
7384 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7385 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7386 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7387 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7388 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7389
7390 @end table
7391
7392 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7393 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7394 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7395
7396 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7397 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7398 @file{charset-test.c}:
7399
7400 @smallexample
7401 #include <stdio.h>
7402
7403 char ascii_hello[]
7404 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7405 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7406 char ibm1047_hello[]
7407 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7408 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7409
7410 main ()
7411 @{
7412 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7413 @}
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7417 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7418 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7419
7420 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7421
7422 @smallexample
7423 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7424 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7425 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7426 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7427 @dots{}
7428 (@value{GDBP})
7429 @end smallexample
7430
7431 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7432 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7433 strings:
7434
7435 @smallexample
7436 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7437 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7438 (@value{GDBP})
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7442 initial character set:
7443 @smallexample
7444 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7445 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7446 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7447 (@value{GDBP})
7448 @end smallexample
7449
7450 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7451 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7452 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7453 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7454 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7455
7456 @smallexample
7457 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7458 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7459 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7460 $2 = 72 'H'
7461 (@value{GDBP})
7462 @end smallexample
7463
7464 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7465 literals you use in expressions:
7466
7467 @smallexample
7468 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7469 $3 = 43 '+'
7470 (@value{GDBP})
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7474 character.
7475
7476 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7477 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7478 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7482 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7483 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7484 $5 = 200 '\310'
7485 (@value{GDBP})
7486 @end smallexample
7487
7488 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7489 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7490
7491 @smallexample
7492 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7493 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7494 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7495 @end smallexample
7496
7497 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7498 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7499 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7500 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7501 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7502
7503 @smallexample
7504 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7505 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7506 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7507 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7508 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7509 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7510 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7511 $7 = 72 '\110'
7512 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7513 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7514 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7515 $9 = 200 'H'
7516 (@value{GDBP})
7517 @end smallexample
7518
7519 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7520 string literals you use in expressions:
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7524 $10 = 78 '+'
7525 (@value{GDBP})
7526 @end smallexample
7527
7528 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7529 character.
7530
7531 @node Caching Remote Data
7532 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7533 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7534
7535 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7536 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7537 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7538 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7539 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7540 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7541 volatile registers are in use.
7542
7543 @table @code
7544 @kindex set remotecache
7545 @item set remotecache on
7546 @itemx set remotecache off
7547 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7548 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7549
7550 @kindex show remotecache
7551 @item show remotecache
7552 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7553
7554 @kindex info dcache
7555 @item info dcache
7556 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7557 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7558 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7559 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7560 the data cache operation.
7561 @end table
7562
7563
7564 @node Macros
7565 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7566
7567 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7568 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7569 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7570 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7571 where it was defined.
7572
7573 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7574 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7575 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7576 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7577
7578 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7579 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7580 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7581 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7582 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7583 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7584 see @ref{List}.
7585
7586 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7587 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7588 variable-arity macros.
7589
7590 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7591 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7592 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7593
7594 @table @code
7595
7596 @kindex macro expand
7597 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7598 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7599 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7600 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7601 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7602 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7603 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7604 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7605 it can be any string of tokens.
7606
7607 @kindex macro exp1
7608 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7609 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7610 @cindex expand macro once
7611 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7612 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7613 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7614 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7615 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7616 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7617 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7618 can be any string of tokens.
7619
7620 @kindex info macro
7621 @cindex macro definition, showing
7622 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7623 @item info macro @var{macro}
7624 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7625 source location where that definition was established.
7626
7627 @kindex macro define
7628 @cindex user-defined macros
7629 @cindex defining macros interactively
7630 @cindex macros, user-defined
7631 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7632 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7633 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7634 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7635 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7636 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7637 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7638 given in @var{arglist}.
7639
7640 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7641 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7642 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7643 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7644 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7645
7646 @kindex macro undef
7647 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7648 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7649 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7650 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7651 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7652 debugged.
7653
7654 @kindex macro list
7655 @item macro list
7656 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7657 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7661 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7662 show our source files:
7663
7664 @smallexample
7665 $ cat sample.c
7666 #include <stdio.h>
7667 #include "sample.h"
7668
7669 #define M 42
7670 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7671
7672 main ()
7673 @{
7674 #define N 28
7675 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7676 #undef N
7677 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7678 #define N 1729
7679 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7680 @}
7681 $ cat sample.h
7682 #define Q <
7683 $
7684 @end smallexample
7685
7686 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7687 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7688 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7689 information.
7690
7691 @smallexample
7692 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7693 $
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7697
7698 @smallexample
7699 $ gdb -nw sample
7700 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7701 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7702 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7703 (@value{GDBP})
7704 @end smallexample
7705
7706 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7707 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7708 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7709
7710 @smallexample
7711 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7712 3
7713 4 #define M 42
7714 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7715 6
7716 7 main ()
7717 8 @{
7718 9 #define N 28
7719 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7720 11 #undef N
7721 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7722 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7723 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7724 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7725 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7726 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7727 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7728 #define Q <
7729 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7730 expands to: (42 + 1)
7731 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7732 expands to: once (M + 1)
7733 (@value{GDBP})
7734 @end smallexample
7735
7736 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7737 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7738 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7739 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7740
7741 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7742 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7743
7744 @smallexample
7745 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7746 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7747 (@value{GDBP}) run
7748 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7749
7750 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7751 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7752 (@value{GDBP})
7753 @end smallexample
7754
7755 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7756
7757 @smallexample
7758 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7759 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7760 #define N 28
7761 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7762 expands to: 28 < 42
7763 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7764 $1 = 1
7765 (@value{GDBP})
7766 @end smallexample
7767
7768 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7769 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7770 thereof) in force at each point:
7771
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) next
7774 Hello, world!
7775 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7776 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7777 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7778 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7779 (@value{GDBP}) next
7780 We're so creative.
7781 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7782 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7783 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7784 #define N 1729
7785 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7786 expands to: 1729 < 42
7787 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7788 $2 = 0
7789 (@value{GDBP})
7790 @end smallexample
7791
7792
7793 @node Tracepoints
7794 @chapter Tracepoints
7795 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7796 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7797
7798 @cindex tracepoints
7799 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7800 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7801 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7802 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7803 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7804 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7805 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7806
7807 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7808 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7809 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7810 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7811 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7812 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7813 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7814 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7815 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7816 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7817 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7818
7819 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7820 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7821 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7822 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7823 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7824 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7825 Packets}.
7826
7827 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7828
7829 @menu
7830 * Set Tracepoints::
7831 * Analyze Collected Data::
7832 * Tracepoint Variables::
7833 @end menu
7834
7835 @node Set Tracepoints
7836 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7837
7838 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7839 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7840 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7841 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7842 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7843 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7844 work on.
7845
7846 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7847 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7848 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7849 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7850 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7851 tracepoint was hit.
7852
7853 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7854 conditions and actions.
7855
7856 @menu
7857 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7858 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7859 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7860 * Tracepoint Actions::
7861 * Listing Tracepoints::
7862 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7863 @end menu
7864
7865 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7866 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7867
7868 @table @code
7869 @cindex set tracepoint
7870 @kindex trace
7871 @item trace
7872 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7873 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7874 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7875 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7876 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7877 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7878 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7879 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7880 running.
7881
7882 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7883
7884 @smallexample
7885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7886
7887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7888
7889 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7890
7891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7892
7893 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7894 @end smallexample
7895
7896 @noindent
7897 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7898
7899 @vindex $tpnum
7900 @cindex last tracepoint number
7901 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7902 @cindex tracepoint number
7903 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7904 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7905
7906 @kindex delete tracepoint
7907 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7908 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7909 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7910 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7911
7912 Examples:
7913
7914 @smallexample
7915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7916
7917 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7918 @end smallexample
7919
7920 @noindent
7921 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7922 @end table
7923
7924 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7925 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7926
7927 @table @code
7928 @kindex disable tracepoint
7929 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7930 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7931 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7932 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7933 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7934
7935 @kindex enable tracepoint
7936 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7937 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7938 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7939 run.
7940 @end table
7941
7942 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7943 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7944
7945 @table @code
7946 @kindex passcount
7947 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7948 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7949 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7950 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7951 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7952 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7953 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7954 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7955 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7956 user.
7957
7958 Examples:
7959
7960 @smallexample
7961 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7962 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7963
7964 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7965 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7967 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7968 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7971 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7972 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7973 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7974 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7975 @end smallexample
7976 @end table
7977
7978 @node Tracepoint Actions
7979 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7980
7981 @table @code
7982 @kindex actions
7983 @cindex tracepoint actions
7984 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7985 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7986 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7987 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7988 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7989 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7990 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7991 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7992 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7993 @code{while-stepping}.
7994
7995 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7996 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7997 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7998
7999 @smallexample
8000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8001
8002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8003
8004 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8005 @end smallexample
8006
8007 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8008 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8009 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8010 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8011 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8012 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8013 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8014 @code{end} command.
8015
8016 @smallexample
8017 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8018 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8019 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8020 > collect bar,baz
8021 > collect $regs
8022 > while-stepping 12
8023 > collect $fp, $sp
8024 > end
8025 end
8026 @end smallexample
8027
8028 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8029 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8030 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8031 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8032 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8033 special arguments are supported:
8034
8035 @table @code
8036 @item $regs
8037 collect all registers
8038
8039 @item $args
8040 collect all function arguments
8041
8042 @item $locals
8043 collect all local variables.
8044 @end table
8045
8046 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8047 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8048 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8049
8050 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8051 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8052
8053 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8054 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8055 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8056 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8057 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8058 its own @code{end} command):
8059
8060 @smallexample
8061 > while-stepping 12
8062 > collect $regs, myglobal
8063 > end
8064 >
8065 @end smallexample
8066
8067 @noindent
8068 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8069 @code{stepping}.
8070 @end table
8071
8072 @node Listing Tracepoints
8073 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8074
8075 @table @code
8076 @kindex info tracepoints
8077 @kindex info tp
8078 @cindex information about tracepoints
8079 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8080 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8081 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8082 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8083 shown:
8084
8085 @itemize @bullet
8086 @item
8087 its number
8088 @item
8089 whether it is enabled or disabled
8090 @item
8091 its address
8092 @item
8093 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8094 @item
8095 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8096 @item
8097 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8098 @item
8099 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8100 @end itemize
8101
8102 @smallexample
8103 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8104 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8105 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8106 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8107 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8108 (@value{GDBP})
8109 @end smallexample
8110
8111 @noindent
8112 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8113 @end table
8114
8115 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8116 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8117
8118 @table @code
8119 @kindex tstart
8120 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8121 @cindex collected data discarded
8122 @item tstart
8123 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8124 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8125 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8126 experiment.
8127
8128 @kindex tstop
8129 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8130 @item tstop
8131 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8132 stops collecting data.
8133
8134 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8135 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8136 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8137
8138 @kindex tstatus
8139 @cindex status of trace data collection
8140 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8141 @item tstatus
8142 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8143 collection.
8144 @end table
8145
8146 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8147
8148 @smallexample
8149 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8151 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8152 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8153 > while-stepping 11
8154 > collect $regs
8155 > end
8156 > end
8157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8158 [time passes @dots{}]
8159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8160 @end smallexample
8161
8162
8163 @node Analyze Collected Data
8164 @section Using the Collected Data
8165
8166 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8167 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8168 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8169 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8170 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8171 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8172 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8173 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8174 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8175 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8176 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8177 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8178 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8179 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8180 the buffer will fail.
8181
8182 @menu
8183 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8184 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8185 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8186 @end menu
8187
8188 @node tfind
8189 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8190
8191 @kindex tfind
8192 @cindex select trace snapshot
8193 @cindex find trace snapshot
8194 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8195 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8196 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8197 snapshot is selected.
8198
8199 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8200
8201 @table @code
8202 @item tfind start
8203 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8204 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8205
8206 @item tfind none
8207 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8208
8209 @item tfind end
8210 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8211
8212 @item tfind
8213 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8214
8215 @item tfind -
8216 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8217 retracing earlier steps.
8218
8219 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8220 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8221 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8222 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8223 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8224
8225 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8226 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8227 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8228 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8229 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8230
8231 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8232 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8233 addresses.
8234
8235 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8236 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8237 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8238
8239 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8240 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8241 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8242 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8243 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8244 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8245 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8246 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8247 @end table
8248
8249 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8250 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8251 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8252 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8253 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8254 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8255 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8256 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8257 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8258 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8259 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8260 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8261 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8262 tracepoint as the current one.
8263
8264 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8265 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8266 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8267 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8268 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8269
8270 @smallexample
8271 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8272 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8273 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8274 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8275 > tfind
8276 > end
8277
8278 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8279 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8280 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8281 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8282 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8283 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8284 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8285 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8286 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8287 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8288 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8292 the buffer:
8293
8294 @smallexample
8295 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8296 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8297 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8298 > tfind line
8299 > end
8300
8301 Frame 0, X = 1
8302 Frame 7, X = 2
8303 Frame 13, X = 255
8304 @end smallexample
8305
8306 @node tdump
8307 @subsection @code{tdump}
8308 @kindex tdump
8309 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8310 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8311
8312 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8313 the current trace snapshot.
8314
8315 @smallexample
8316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8317 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8318 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8319 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8320 > end
8321
8322 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8323
8324 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8325 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8326 at gdb_test.c:444
8327 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8328
8329 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8330 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8331 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8332 d1 0x18 24
8333 d2 0x80 128
8334 d3 0x33 51
8335 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8336 d5 0x22 34
8337 d6 0xe0 224
8338 d7 0x380035 3670069
8339 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8340 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8341 a2 0x100 256
8342 a3 0x322000 3284992
8343 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8344 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8345 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8346 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8347 ps 0x0 0
8348 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8349 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8350 fpstatus 0x0 0
8351 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8352 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8353 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8354 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8355 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8356 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8357 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8358 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8359 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8360
8361 (@value{GDBP})
8362 @end smallexample
8363
8364 @node save-tracepoints
8365 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8366 @kindex save-tracepoints
8367 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8368
8369 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8370 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8371 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8372 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8373 Files}).
8374
8375 @node Tracepoint Variables
8376 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8377 @cindex tracepoint variables
8378 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8379
8380 @table @code
8381 @vindex $trace_frame
8382 @item (int) $trace_frame
8383 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8384 snapshot is selected.
8385
8386 @vindex $tracepoint
8387 @item (int) $tracepoint
8388 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8389
8390 @vindex $trace_line
8391 @item (int) $trace_line
8392 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8393
8394 @vindex $trace_file
8395 @item (char []) $trace_file
8396 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8397
8398 @vindex $trace_func
8399 @item (char []) $trace_func
8400 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8401 @end table
8402
8403 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8404 use @code{output} instead.
8405
8406 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8407 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8408 data.
8409
8410 @smallexample
8411 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8412
8413 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8414 > output $trace_file
8415 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8416 > tfind
8417 > end
8418 @end smallexample
8419
8420 @node Overlays
8421 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8422 @cindex overlays
8423
8424 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8425 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8426 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8427 use overlays.
8428
8429 @menu
8430 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8431 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8432 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8433 mapped by asking the inferior.
8434 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8435 @end menu
8436
8437 @node How Overlays Work
8438 @section How Overlays Work
8439 @cindex mapped overlays
8440 @cindex unmapped overlays
8441 @cindex load address, overlay's
8442 @cindex mapped address
8443 @cindex overlay area
8444
8445 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8446 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8447 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8448 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8449 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8450
8451 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8452 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8453 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8454 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8455 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8456 largest overlay as well.
8457
8458 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8459 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8460 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8461 there.
8462
8463 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8464 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8465 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8466
8467 @smallexample
8468 @group
8469 Data Instruction Larger
8470 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8471 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8472 | | | | | |
8473 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8474 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8475 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8476 | and heap | | | | | |
8477 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8478 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8479 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8480 | | | | | |
8481 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8482 address | | | | | |
8483 | overlay | <-' | | |
8484 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8485 | | <---. | | load address
8486 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8487 | | | |
8488 +-----------+ | |
8489 +-----------+
8490 | |
8491 +-----------+
8492
8493 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8494 @end group
8495 @end smallexample
8496
8497 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8498 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8499 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8500 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8501 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8502 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8503 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8504 program and the overlay area.
8505
8506 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8507 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8508 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8509 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8510 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8511 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8512 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8513
8514 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8515 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8516 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8517
8518 @itemize @bullet
8519
8520 @item
8521 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8522 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8523 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8524 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8525
8526 @item
8527 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8528 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8529 your program's performance.
8530
8531 @item
8532 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8533 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8534 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8535 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8536 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8537 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8538 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8539
8540 @item
8541 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8542 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8543 instruction and data spaces.
8544
8545 @end itemize
8546
8547 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8548 improved in many ways:
8549
8550 @itemize @bullet
8551
8552 @item
8553 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8554 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8555 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8556 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8557 area in the usual way.
8558
8559 @item
8560 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8561 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8562
8563 @item
8564 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8565 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8566 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8567 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8568 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8569 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8570 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8571
8572 @end itemize
8573
8574
8575 @node Overlay Commands
8576 @section Overlay Commands
8577
8578 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8579 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8580 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8581 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8582 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8583 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8584
8585 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8586 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8587
8588 @table @code
8589 @item overlay off
8590 @kindex overlay
8591 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8592 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8593 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8594 overlay support is disabled.
8595
8596 @item overlay manual
8597 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8598 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8599 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8600 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8601 commands described below.
8602
8603 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8604 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8605 @cindex map an overlay
8606 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8607 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8608 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8609 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8610 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8611 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8612
8613 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8614 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8615 @cindex unmap an overlay
8616 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8617 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8618 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8619 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8620
8621 @item overlay auto
8622 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8623 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8624 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8625 Overlay Debugging}.
8626
8627 @item overlay load-target
8628 @itemx overlay load
8629 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8630 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8631 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8632 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8633 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8634 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8635
8636 @item overlay list-overlays
8637 @itemx overlay list
8638 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8639 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8640 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8641
8642 @end table
8643
8644 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8645 of the function the address falls in:
8646
8647 @smallexample
8648 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8649 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8650 @end smallexample
8651 @noindent
8652 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8653 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8654 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8655 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8656
8657 @smallexample
8658 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8659 No sections are mapped.
8660 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8661 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8662 @end smallexample
8663 @noindent
8664 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8665 name normally:
8666
8667 @smallexample
8668 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8669 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8670 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8671 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8672 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8673 @end smallexample
8674
8675 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8676 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8677 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8678 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8679 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8680
8681 @itemize @bullet
8682 @item
8683 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8684 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8685 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8686 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8687 @item
8688 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8689 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8690 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8691 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8692 breakpoints properly.
8693 @end itemize
8694
8695
8696 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8697 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8698 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8699
8700 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8701 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8702 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8703 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8704 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8705 current state of the overlays.
8706
8707 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8708 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8709
8710 @table @asis
8711
8712 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8713 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8714
8715 @smallexample
8716 struct
8717 @{
8718 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8719 unsigned long vma;
8720
8721 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8722 unsigned long size;
8723
8724 /* The overlay's load address. */
8725 unsigned long lma;
8726
8727 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8728 zero otherwise. */
8729 unsigned long mapped;
8730 @}
8731 @end smallexample
8732
8733 @item @code{_novlys}:
8734 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8735 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8736
8737 @end table
8738
8739 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8740 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8741 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8742 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8743 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8744 currently mapped.
8745
8746 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8747 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8748 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8749 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8750 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8751 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8752 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8753 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8754 are not being executed.
8755
8756 @node Overlay Sample Program
8757 @section Overlay Sample Program
8758 @cindex overlay example program
8759
8760 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8761 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8762 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8763 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8764 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8765 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8766 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8767
8768 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8769 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8770 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8771 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8772
8773 @table @file
8774 @item overlays.c
8775 The main program file.
8776 @item ovlymgr.c
8777 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8778 @item foo.c
8779 @itemx bar.c
8780 @itemx baz.c
8781 @itemx grbx.c
8782 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8783 @item d10v.ld
8784 @itemx m32r.ld
8785 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8786 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8787 @end table
8788
8789 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8790 cross-compiler like this:
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8794 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8795 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8796 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8797 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8798 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8799 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8800 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8801 @end smallexample
8802
8803 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8804 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8805 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8806
8807
8808 @node Languages
8809 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8810 @cindex languages
8811
8812 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8813 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8814 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8815 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8816 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8817 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8818
8819 @cindex working language
8820 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8821 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8822 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8823 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8824 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8825 language}.
8826
8827 @menu
8828 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8829 * Show:: Displaying the language
8830 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8831 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8832 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8833 @end menu
8834
8835 @node Setting
8836 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8837
8838 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8839 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8840 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8841 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8842 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8843 are printed, etc.
8844
8845 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8846 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8847 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8848 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8849 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8850 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8851 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8852 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8853 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8854 Displaying the Language}.
8855
8856 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8857 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8858 another language. In that case, make the
8859 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8860 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8861 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8862
8863 @menu
8864 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8865 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8866 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8867 @end menu
8868
8869 @node Filenames
8870 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8871
8872 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8873 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8874
8875 @table @file
8876 @item .ada
8877 @itemx .ads
8878 @itemx .adb
8879 @itemx .a
8880 Ada source file.
8881
8882 @item .c
8883 C source file
8884
8885 @item .C
8886 @itemx .cc
8887 @itemx .cp
8888 @itemx .cpp
8889 @itemx .cxx
8890 @itemx .c++
8891 C@t{++} source file
8892
8893 @item .m
8894 Objective-C source file
8895
8896 @item .f
8897 @itemx .F
8898 Fortran source file
8899
8900 @item .mod
8901 Modula-2 source file
8902
8903 @item .s
8904 @itemx .S
8905 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8906 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8907 @end table
8908
8909 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8910 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8911
8912 @node Manually
8913 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8914
8915 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8916 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8917 your program.
8918
8919 @kindex set language
8920 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8921 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8922 a language, such as
8923 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8924 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8925
8926 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8927 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8928 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8929 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8930 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8931 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8932 command such as:
8933
8934 @smallexample
8935 print a = b + c
8936 @end smallexample
8937
8938 @noindent
8939 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8940 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8941 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8942 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8943
8944 @node Automatically
8945 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8946
8947 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8948 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8949 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8950 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8951 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8952 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8953 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8954 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8955 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8956
8957 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8958 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8959 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8960 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8961 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8962
8963 @node Show
8964 @section Displaying the Language
8965
8966 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8967 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8968
8969 @table @code
8970 @item show language
8971 @kindex show language
8972 Display the current working language. This is the
8973 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8974 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8975
8976 @item info frame
8977 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8978 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8979 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8980 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8981 information listed here.
8982
8983 @item info source
8984 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8985 Display the source language of this source file.
8986 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8987 information listed here.
8988 @end table
8989
8990 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8991 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8992 with a language explicitly:
8993
8994 @table @code
8995 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8996 @kindex set extension-language
8997 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8998 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8999
9000 @item info extensions
9001 @kindex info extensions
9002 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9003 @end table
9004
9005 @node Checks
9006 @section Type and Range Checking
9007
9008 @quotation
9009 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9010 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9011 section documents the intended facilities.
9012 @end quotation
9013 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9014
9015 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9016 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9017 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9018 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9019 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9020 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9021 errors when your program is running.
9022
9023 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9024 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9025 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9026 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9027 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9028 automatically based on your program's source language.
9029 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9030 settings of supported languages.
9031
9032 @menu
9033 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9034 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9035 @end menu
9036
9037 @cindex type checking
9038 @cindex checks, type
9039 @node Type Checking
9040 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9041
9042 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9043 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9044 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9045 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9046
9047 @smallexample
9048 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9049 @exdent but
9050 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9051 @end smallexample
9052
9053 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9054 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9055
9056 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9057 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9058 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9059 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9060 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9061 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9062 also issues a warning.
9063
9064 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9065 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9066 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9067 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9068 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9069 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9070
9071 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9072 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9073 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9074 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9075 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9076 details on specific languages.
9077
9078 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9079
9080 @kindex set check type
9081 @kindex show check type
9082 @table @code
9083 @item set check type auto
9084 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9085 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9086 each language.
9087
9088 @item set check type on
9089 @itemx set check type off
9090 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9091 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9092 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9093 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9094 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9095
9096 @item set check type warn
9097 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9098 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9099 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9100 numbers and structures.
9101
9102 @item show type
9103 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9104 is setting it automatically.
9105 @end table
9106
9107 @cindex range checking
9108 @cindex checks, range
9109 @node Range Checking
9110 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9111
9112 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9113 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9114 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9115 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9116 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9117
9118 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9119 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9120 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9121 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9122
9123 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9124 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9125 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9126 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9127 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9128 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9129
9130 @smallexample
9131 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9132 @end smallexample
9133
9134 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9135 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9136 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9137
9138 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9139
9140 @kindex set check range
9141 @kindex show check range
9142 @table @code
9143 @item set check range auto
9144 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9145 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9146 each language.
9147
9148 @item set check range on
9149 @itemx set check range off
9150 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9151 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9152 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9153 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9154
9155 @item set check range warn
9156 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9157 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9158 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9159 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9160 systems).
9161
9162 @item show range
9163 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9164 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9165 @end table
9166
9167 @node Supported Languages
9168 @section Supported Languages
9169
9170 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9171 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9172 @c This is false ...
9173 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9174 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9175 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9176 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9177 language.
9178
9179 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9180 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9181 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9182 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9183 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9184 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9185 language reference or tutorial.
9186
9187 @menu
9188 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9189 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9190 * Fortran:: Fortran
9191 * Pascal:: Pascal
9192 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9193 * Ada:: Ada
9194 @end menu
9195
9196 @node C
9197 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9198
9199 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9200 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9201
9202 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9203 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9204 together.
9205
9206 @cindex C@t{++}
9207 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9208 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9209 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9210 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9211 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9212 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9213 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9214
9215 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9216 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9217 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9218 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9219 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9220 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9221
9222 @menu
9223 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9224 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9225 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9226 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9227 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9228 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9229 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9230 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9231 @end menu
9232
9233 @node C Operators
9234 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9235
9236 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9237
9238 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9239 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9240 often defined on groups of types.
9241
9242 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9243
9244 @itemize @bullet
9245
9246 @item
9247 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9248 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9249
9250 @item
9251 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9252 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9253
9254 @item
9255 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9256
9257 @item
9258 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9259
9260 @end itemize
9261
9262 @noindent
9263 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9264 in order of increasing precedence:
9265
9266 @table @code
9267 @item ,
9268 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9269 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9270 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9271
9272 @item =
9273 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9274 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9275
9276 @item @var{op}=
9277 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9278 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9279 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9280 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9281 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9282
9283 @item ?:
9284 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9285 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9286 integral type.
9287
9288 @item ||
9289 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9290
9291 @item &&
9292 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9293
9294 @item |
9295 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9296
9297 @item ^
9298 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9299
9300 @item &
9301 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9302
9303 @item ==@r{, }!=
9304 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9305 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9306
9307 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9308 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9309 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9310 and non-zero for true.
9311
9312 @item <<@r{, }>>
9313 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9314
9315 @item @@
9316 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9317
9318 @item +@r{, }-
9319 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9320 pointer types.
9321
9322 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9323 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9324 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9325 integral types.
9326
9327 @item ++@r{, }--
9328 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9329 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9330 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9331 operation takes place.
9332
9333 @item *
9334 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9335 @code{++}.
9336
9337 @item &
9338 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9339
9340 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9341 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9342 to examine the address
9343 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9344 stored.
9345
9346 @item -
9347 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9348 precedence as @code{++}.
9349
9350 @item !
9351 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9352 @code{++}.
9353
9354 @item ~
9355 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9356 @code{++}.
9357
9358
9359 @item .@r{, }->
9360 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9361 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9362 pointer based on the stored type information.
9363 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9364
9365 @item .*@r{, }->*
9366 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9367
9368 @item []
9369 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9370 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9371
9372 @item ()
9373 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9374
9375 @item ::
9376 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9377 and @code{class} types.
9378
9379 @item ::
9380 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9381 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9382 above.
9383 @end table
9384
9385 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9386 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9387 predefined meaning.
9388
9389 @node C Constants
9390 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9391
9392 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9393
9394 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9395 following ways:
9396
9397 @itemize @bullet
9398 @item
9399 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9400 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9401 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9402 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9403 @code{long} value.
9404
9405 @item
9406 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9407 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9408 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9409 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9410 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9411 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9412 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9413 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9414 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9415 constant.
9416
9417 @item
9418 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9419 integral equivalents.
9420
9421 @item
9422 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9423 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9424 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9425 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9426 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9427 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9428 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9429 @samp{\n} for newline.
9430
9431 @item
9432 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9433 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9434 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9435 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9436 characters.
9437
9438 @item
9439 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9440 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9441
9442 @item
9443 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9444 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9445 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9446 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9447 @end itemize
9448
9449 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9450 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9451
9452 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9453 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9454
9455 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9456 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9457 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9458 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9459 @quotation
9460 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9461 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9462 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9463 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9464 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9465 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9466 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9467 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9468 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9469 C@t{++} code.
9470 @end quotation
9471
9472 @enumerate
9473
9474 @cindex member functions
9475 @item
9476 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9477
9478 @smallexample
9479 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9483 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9484 @item
9485 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9486 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9487 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9488 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9489
9490 @cindex call overloaded functions
9491 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9492 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9493 @item
9494 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9495 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9496 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9497 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9498 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9499 default arguments.
9500
9501 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9502 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9503 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9504 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9505 number of function arguments.
9506
9507 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9508 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9509 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9510
9511 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9512 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9513 @smallexample
9514 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9518 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9519
9520 @cindex reference declarations
9521 @item
9522 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9523 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9524 dereferenced.
9525
9526 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9527 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9528 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9529 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9530 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9531
9532 @item
9533 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9534 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9535 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9536 necessary, for example in an expression like
9537 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9538 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9539 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9540 @end enumerate
9541
9542 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9543 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9544 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9545 invoking user-defined operators.
9546
9547 @node C Defaults
9548 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9549
9550 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9551
9552 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9553 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9554 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9555 selects the working language.
9556
9557 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9558 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9559 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9560 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9561 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9562 for further details.
9563
9564 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9565 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9566 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9567
9568 @node C Checks
9569 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9570
9571 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9572
9573 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9574 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9575 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9576
9577 @itemize @bullet
9578 @item
9579 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9580 enumerated tag.
9581
9582 @item
9583 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9584 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9585
9586 @ignore
9587 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9588 @c FIXME--beers?
9589 @item
9590 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9591 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9592 compilers.)
9593 @end ignore
9594 @end itemize
9595
9596 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9597 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9598 that is not itself an array.
9599
9600 @node Debugging C
9601 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9602
9603 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9604 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9605 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9606 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9607
9608 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9609 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9610 ,Expressions}.
9611
9612 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9613 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9614
9615 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9616
9617 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9618 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9619
9620 @table @code
9621 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9622 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9623 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9624 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9625 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9626
9627 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9628 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9629 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9630 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9631 classes.
9632 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9633
9634 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9635 @item catch throw
9636 @itemx catch catch
9637 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9638 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9639
9640 @cindex inheritance
9641 @item ptype @var{typename}
9642 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9643 @var{typename}.
9644 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9645
9646 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9647 @item set print demangle
9648 @itemx show print demangle
9649 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9650 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9651 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9652 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9653 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9654
9655 @item set print object
9656 @itemx show print object
9657 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9658 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9659
9660 @item set print vtbl
9661 @itemx show print vtbl
9662 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9663 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9664 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9665 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9666
9667 @kindex set overload-resolution
9668 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9669 @item set overload-resolution on
9670 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9671 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9672 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9673 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9674 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9675 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9676
9677 @item set overload-resolution off
9678 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9679 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9680 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9681 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9682 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9683 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9684 argument types.
9685
9686 @kindex show overload-resolution
9687 @item show overload-resolution
9688 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9689
9690 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9691 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9692 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9693 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9694 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9695 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9696 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9697 @end table
9698
9699 @node Decimal Floating Point
9700 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9701 @cindex decimal floating point format
9702
9703 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9704 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9705 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9706 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9707
9708 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9709 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9710 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9711 target.
9712
9713 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9714 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9715 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9716
9717 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9718 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9719 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9720
9721 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9722 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9723 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9724
9725 @node Objective-C
9726 @subsection Objective-C
9727
9728 @cindex Objective-C
9729 This section provides information about some commands and command
9730 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9731 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9732 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9733
9734 @menu
9735 * Method Names in Commands::
9736 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9737 @end menu
9738
9739 @node Method Names in Commands
9740 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9741
9742 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9743 names as line specifications:
9744
9745 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9746 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9747 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9748 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9749 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9750 @itemize
9751 @item @code{clear}
9752 @item @code{break}
9753 @item @code{info line}
9754 @item @code{jump}
9755 @item @code{list}
9756 @end itemize
9757
9758 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9759
9760 @smallexample
9761 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9762 @end smallexample
9763
9764 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9765 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9766 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9767 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9768 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9769 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9770 debugged, enter:
9771
9772 @smallexample
9773 break -[Fruit create]
9774 @end smallexample
9775
9776 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9777 enter:
9778
9779 @smallexample
9780 list +[NSText initialize]
9781 @end smallexample
9782
9783 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9784 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9785 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9786 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9787
9788 @smallexample
9789 break create
9790 @end smallexample
9791
9792 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9793 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9794 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9795 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9796 none apply.
9797
9798 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9799 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9800
9801 @smallexample
9802 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9803 @end smallexample
9804
9805 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9806 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9807 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9808 @kindex print-object
9809 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9810
9811 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9812
9813 @smallexample
9814 print -[@var{object} hash]
9815 @end smallexample
9816
9817 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9818 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9819 @noindent
9820 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9821 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9822 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9823 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9824 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9825 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9826
9827 @node Fortran
9828 @subsection Fortran
9829 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9830
9831 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9832 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9833
9834 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9835 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9836 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9837 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9838 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9839 underscore.
9840
9841 @menu
9842 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9843 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9844 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9845 @end menu
9846
9847 @node Fortran Operators
9848 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9849
9850 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9851
9852 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9853 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9854 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9855
9856 @table @code
9857 @item **
9858 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9859 of the second one.
9860
9861 @item :
9862 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9863 represent a section of array.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 @node Fortran Defaults
9867 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9868
9869 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9870
9871 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9872 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9873 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9874 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9875
9876 @node Special Fortran Commands
9877 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9878
9879 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9880
9881 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9882 such as displaying common blocks.
9883
9884 @table @code
9885 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9886 @kindex info common
9887 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9888 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9889 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9890 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9891 printed.
9892 @end table
9893
9894 @node Pascal
9895 @subsection Pascal
9896
9897 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9898 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9899 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9900 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9901 syntax.
9902
9903 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9904 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9905 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9906
9907 @node Modula-2
9908 @subsection Modula-2
9909
9910 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9911
9912 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9913 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9914 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9915 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9916 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9917 table.
9918
9919 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9920 @menu
9921 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9922 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9923 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9924 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9925 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9926 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9927 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9928 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9929 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9930 @end menu
9931
9932 @node M2 Operators
9933 @subsubsection Operators
9934 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9935
9936 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9937 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9938 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9939 following definitions hold:
9940
9941 @itemize @bullet
9942
9943 @item
9944 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9945 their subranges.
9946
9947 @item
9948 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9949
9950 @item
9951 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9952
9953 @item
9954 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9955 @var{type}}.
9956
9957 @item
9958 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9959
9960 @item
9961 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9962
9963 @item
9964 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9965 @end itemize
9966
9967 @noindent
9968 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9969 increasing precedence:
9970
9971 @table @code
9972 @item ,
9973 Function argument or array index separator.
9974
9975 @item :=
9976 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9977 @var{value}.
9978
9979 @item <@r{, }>
9980 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9981 types.
9982
9983 @item <=@r{, }>=
9984 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9985 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9986 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9987
9988 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9989 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9990 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9991 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9992 comment character.
9993
9994 @item IN
9995 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9996 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9997
9998 @item OR
9999 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10000
10001 @item AND@r{, }&
10002 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10003
10004 @item @@
10005 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10006
10007 @item +@r{, }-
10008 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10009 and difference on set types.
10010
10011 @item *
10012 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10013 on set types.
10014
10015 @item /
10016 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10017 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10018
10019 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10020 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10021 precedence as @code{*}.
10022
10023 @item -
10024 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10025
10026 @item ^
10027 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10028
10029 @item NOT
10030 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10031 @code{^}.
10032
10033 @item .
10034 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10035 precedence as @code{^}.
10036
10037 @item []
10038 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10039
10040 @item ()
10041 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10042 as @code{^}.
10043
10044 @item ::@r{, }.
10045 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10046 @end table
10047
10048 @quotation
10049 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10050 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10051 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10052 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10053 @end quotation
10054
10055
10056 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10057 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10058 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10059
10060 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10061 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10062
10063 @table @var
10064
10065 @item a
10066 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10067
10068 @item c
10069 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10070
10071 @item i
10072 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10073
10074 @item m
10075 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10076 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10077 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10078
10079 @item n
10080 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10081
10082 @item r
10083 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10084
10085 @item t
10086 represents a type.
10087
10088 @item v
10089 represents a variable.
10090
10091 @item x
10092 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10093 explanation of the function for details.
10094 @end table
10095
10096 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10097
10098 @table @code
10099 @item ABS(@var{n})
10100 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10101
10102 @item CAP(@var{c})
10103 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10104 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10105
10106 @item CHR(@var{i})
10107 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10108
10109 @item DEC(@var{v})
10110 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10111
10112 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10113 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10114 new value.
10115
10116 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10117 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10118 set.
10119
10120 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10121 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10122
10123 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10124 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10125
10126 @item INC(@var{v})
10127 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10128
10129 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10130 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10131 new value.
10132
10133 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10134 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10135 there. Returns the new set.
10136
10137 @item MAX(@var{t})
10138 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10139
10140 @item MIN(@var{t})
10141 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10142
10143 @item ODD(@var{i})
10144 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10145
10146 @item ORD(@var{x})
10147 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10148 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10149 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10150 integral, character and enumerated types.
10151
10152 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10153 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10154
10155 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10156 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10157
10158 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10159 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10160
10161 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10162 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10163 @end table
10164
10165 @quotation
10166 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10167 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10168 an error.
10169 @end quotation
10170
10171 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10172 @node M2 Constants
10173 @subsubsection Constants
10174
10175 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10176 ways:
10177
10178 @itemize @bullet
10179
10180 @item
10181 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10182 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10183 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10184 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10185
10186 @item
10187 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10188 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10189 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10190 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10191 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10192 digits.
10193
10194 @item
10195 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10196 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10197 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10198 followed by a @samp{C}.
10199
10200 @item
10201 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10202 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10203 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10204 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10205 sequences.
10206
10207 @item
10208 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10209
10210 @item
10211 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10212 @code{FALSE}.
10213
10214 @item
10215 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10216
10217 @item
10218 Set constants are not yet supported.
10219 @end itemize
10220
10221 @node M2 Types
10222 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10223 @cindex Modula-2 types
10224
10225 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10226 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10227 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10228 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10229 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10230 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10231
10232 The first example contains the following section of code:
10233
10234 @smallexample
10235 VAR
10236 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10237 r: [20..40] ;
10238 @end smallexample
10239
10240 @noindent
10241 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10242 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10243
10244 @smallexample
10245 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10246 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10247 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10248 SET OF CHAR
10249 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10250 21
10251 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10252 [20..40]
10253 @end smallexample
10254
10255 @noindent
10256 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10257
10258 @smallexample
10259 VAR
10260 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10261 @end smallexample
10262
10263 @noindent
10264 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10265
10266 @smallexample
10267 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10268 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10269 @end smallexample
10270
10271 @noindent
10272 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10273 expressions using the debugger.
10274
10275 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10276 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10277
10278 @smallexample
10279 VAR
10280 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10281 @end smallexample
10282
10283 @smallexample
10284 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10285 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10286 @end smallexample
10287
10288 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10289 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10290 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10291 above.
10292
10293 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 TYPE
10297 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10298 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10299 VAR
10300 s: t ;
10301 BEGIN
10302 s := blue ;
10303 @end smallexample
10304
10305 @noindent
10306 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10307 and value of a variable.
10308
10309 @smallexample
10310 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10311 $1 = blue
10312 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10313 type = [blue..yellow]
10314 @end smallexample
10315
10316 @noindent
10317 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10318 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10319 their @code{C} counterparts.
10320
10321 @smallexample
10322 VAR
10323 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10324 BEGIN
10325 s[1] := 1 ;
10326 @end smallexample
10327
10328 @smallexample
10329 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10330 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10331 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10332 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10333 @end smallexample
10334
10335 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10336 pointer types as shown in this example:
10337
10338 @smallexample
10339 VAR
10340 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10341 BEGIN
10342 NEW(s) ;
10343 s^[1] := 1 ;
10344 @end smallexample
10345
10346 @noindent
10347 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10348
10349 @smallexample
10350 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10351 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10352 @end smallexample
10353
10354 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10355 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10356 types:
10357
10358 @smallexample
10359 TYPE
10360 foo = RECORD
10361 f1: CARDINAL ;
10362 f2: CHAR ;
10363 f3: myarray ;
10364 END ;
10365
10366 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10367 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10368 VAR
10369 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10370 @end smallexample
10371
10372 @noindent
10373 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10374 below.
10375
10376 @smallexample
10377 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10378 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10379 f1 : CARDINAL;
10380 f2 : CHAR;
10381 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10382 END
10383 @end smallexample
10384
10385 @node M2 Defaults
10386 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10387 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10388
10389 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10390 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10391 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10392 selected the working language.
10393
10394 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10395 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10396 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10397 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10398
10399 @node Deviations
10400 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10401 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10402
10403 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10404 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10405
10406 @itemize @bullet
10407 @item
10408 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10409 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10410 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10411 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10412 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10413 returned a pointer.)
10414
10415 @item
10416 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10417 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10418 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10419 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10420
10421 @item
10422 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10423 argument.
10424
10425 @item
10426 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10427 @end itemize
10428
10429 @node M2 Checks
10430 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10431 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10432
10433 @quotation
10434 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10435 range checking.
10436 @end quotation
10437 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10438
10439 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10440
10441 @itemize @bullet
10442 @item
10443 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10444 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10445
10446 @item
10447 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10448 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10449 @end itemize
10450
10451 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10452 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10453
10454 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10455 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10456
10457 @node M2 Scope
10458 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10459 @cindex scope
10460 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10461 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10462 @ifinfo
10463 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10464 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10465 @end ifinfo
10466 @iftex
10467 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10468 @end iftex
10469
10470 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10471 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10472 similar syntax:
10473
10474 @smallexample
10475
10476 @var{module} . @var{id}
10477 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10478 @end smallexample
10479
10480 @noindent
10481 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10482 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10483 identifier within your program, except another module.
10484
10485 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10486 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10487 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10488 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10489
10490 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10491 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10492 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10493 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10494 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10495 @var{module}.
10496
10497 @node GDB/M2
10498 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10499
10500 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10501 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10502 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10503 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10504 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10505 analogue in Modula-2.
10506
10507 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10508 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10509 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10510 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10511 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10512 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10513
10514 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10515 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10516 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10517
10518 @node Ada
10519 @subsection Ada
10520 @cindex Ada
10521
10522 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10523 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10524 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10525 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10526 to be difficult.
10527
10528
10529 @cindex expressions in Ada
10530 @menu
10531 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10532 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10533 in @value{GDBN}.
10534 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10535 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10536 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10537 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10538 @end menu
10539
10540 @node Ada Mode Intro
10541 @subsubsection Introduction
10542 @cindex Ada mode, general
10543
10544 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10545 syntax, with some extensions.
10546 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10547
10548 @itemize @bullet
10549 @item
10550 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10551 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10552 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10553 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10554
10555 @item
10556 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10557 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10558
10559 @item
10560 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10561 @end itemize
10562
10563 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10564 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10565 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10566 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10567 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10568
10569 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10570 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10571 was translated from an Ada source file.
10572
10573 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10574 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10575 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10576 middle (to allow based literals).
10577
10578 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10579 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10580 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10581 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10582 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10583 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10584
10585 @node Omissions from Ada
10586 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10587 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10588
10589 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10590
10591 @itemize @bullet
10592 @item
10593 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10594
10595 @itemize @minus
10596 @item
10597 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10598 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10599
10600 @item
10601 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10602
10603 @item
10604 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10605
10606 @item
10607 @t{'Tag}.
10608
10609 @item
10610 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10611 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10612
10613 @item
10614 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10615 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10616
10617 @item
10618 @t{'Address}.
10619 @end itemize
10620
10621 @item
10622 The names in
10623 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10624 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10625 not currently available.
10626
10627 @item
10628 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10629 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10630 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10631 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10632 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10633 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10634 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10635 indeterminate values.
10636
10637 @item
10638 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10639 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10640 are not implemented.
10641
10642 @item
10643 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10644 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10645 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10646 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10647 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10648
10649 @smallexample
10650 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10651 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10652 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10653 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10654 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10655 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 Changing a
10659 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10660 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10661 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10662 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10663 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10664 declared to have a type such as:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10668 Id : Integer;
10669 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10670 end record;
10671 @end smallexample
10672
10673 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10674 assignments:
10675
10676 @smallexample
10677 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10678 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10679 @end smallexample
10680
10681 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10682 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10683 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10684 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10685 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10686 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10687 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10688 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10689
10690 @item
10691 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10692
10693 @item
10694 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10695 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10696 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10697 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10698 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10699 the proper resolution.
10700
10701 @item
10702 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10703
10704 @item
10705 Entry calls are not implemented.
10706
10707 @item
10708 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10709 formats are not supported.
10710
10711 @item
10712 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10713 @end itemize
10714
10715 @node Additions to Ada
10716 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10717 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10718
10719 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10720 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10721
10722 @itemize @bullet
10723 @item
10724 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10725 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10726 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10727 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10728 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10729 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10730 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10731 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10732
10733 @item
10734 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10735 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10736 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10737
10738 @item
10739 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10740 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10741
10742 @item
10743 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10744 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10745 @end itemize
10746
10747 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10748 additions specific to Ada:
10749
10750 @itemize @bullet
10751 @item
10752 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10753 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10754
10755 @smallexample
10756 set x := y + 3
10757 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10758 @end smallexample
10759
10760 @item
10761 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10762 the value of its right-hand operand.
10763 This allows, for example,
10764 complex conditional breaks:
10765
10766 @smallexample
10767 break f
10768 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10769 @end smallexample
10770
10771 @item
10772 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10773 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10774 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10775 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10776 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10777 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10778 in strings. For example,
10779 @smallexample
10780 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10781 @end smallexample
10782 @noindent
10783 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10784 after each period.
10785
10786 @item
10787 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10788 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10789 to write
10790
10791 @smallexample
10792 print 'max(x, y)
10793 @end smallexample
10794
10795 @item
10796 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10797 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10798 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10799 of 3 might print as
10800
10801 @smallexample
10802 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10803 @end smallexample
10804
10805 @noindent
10806 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10807 clause.
10808
10809 @item
10810 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10811 multi-character subsequence of
10812 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10813 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10814 in place of @t{a'length}.
10815
10816 @item
10817 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10818 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10819 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10820 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10821 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10822 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10823 For example,
10824 @smallexample
10825 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10826 @end smallexample
10827
10828 @item
10829 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10830 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10831 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10832 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10833 object.
10834
10835 @end itemize
10836
10837 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10838 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10839
10840 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10841 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10842 before reaching the main procedure.
10843 As defined in the Ada Reference
10844 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10845 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10846 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10847 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10848
10849 @node Ada Glitches
10850 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10851 @cindex Ada, problems
10852
10853 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10854 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10855 @value{GDBN},
10856 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10857 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10858
10859 @itemize @bullet
10860 @item
10861 Currently, the debugger
10862 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10863 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10864 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10865 to get it printed properly.
10866
10867 @item
10868 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10869 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10870
10871 @item
10872 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10873 argument lists are treated as positional).
10874
10875 @item
10876 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10877
10878 @item
10879 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10880 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10881 the host machine.
10882
10883 @item
10884 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10885
10886 @item
10887 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10888 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10889 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10890 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10891 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10892 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10893 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10894 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10895 you can usually resolve the confusion
10896 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10897 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10898 @end itemize
10899
10900 @node Unsupported Languages
10901 @section Unsupported Languages
10902
10903 @cindex unsupported languages
10904 @cindex minimal language
10905 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10906 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10907 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10908 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10909 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10910 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10911
10912 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10913 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10914 language.
10915
10916 @node Symbols
10917 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10918
10919 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10920 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10921 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10922 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10923 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10924 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10925 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10926
10927 @cindex symbol names
10928 @cindex names of symbols
10929 @cindex quoting names
10930 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10931 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10932 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10933 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10934 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10935 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10936 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10937 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10938
10939 @smallexample
10940 p 'foo.c'::x
10941 @end smallexample
10942
10943 @noindent
10944 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10945
10946 @table @code
10947 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10948 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10949 @kindex set case-sensitive
10950 @item set case-sensitive on
10951 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10952 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10953 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10954 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10955 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10956 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10957 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10958 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10959 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10960 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10961 case-insensitive matches.
10962
10963 @kindex show case-sensitive
10964 @item show case-sensitive
10965 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10966 lookups.
10967
10968 @kindex info address
10969 @cindex address of a symbol
10970 @item info address @var{symbol}
10971 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10972 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10973 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10974 is always stored.
10975
10976 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10977 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10978 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10979
10980 @kindex info symbol
10981 @cindex symbol from address
10982 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10983 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10984 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10985 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10986 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10987
10988 @smallexample
10989 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10990 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10991 @end smallexample
10992
10993 @noindent
10994 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10995 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10996
10997 @kindex whatis
10998 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10999 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11000 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11001 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11002 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11003 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11004 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11005 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11006 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11007 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11008 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11009
11010 @kindex ptype
11011 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11012 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11013 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11014 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11015
11016 For example, for this variable declaration:
11017
11018 @smallexample
11019 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11020 @end smallexample
11021
11022 @noindent
11023 the two commands give this output:
11024
11025 @smallexample
11026 @group
11027 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11028 type = struct complex
11029 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11030 type = struct complex @{
11031 double real;
11032 double imag;
11033 @}
11034 @end group
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 @noindent
11038 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11039 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11040
11041 @cindex incomplete type
11042 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11043 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11044 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11045 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11046 given these declarations:
11047
11048 @smallexample
11049 struct foo;
11050 struct foo *fooptr;
11051 @end smallexample
11052
11053 @noindent
11054 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11055
11056 @smallexample
11057 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11058 $1 = <incomplete type>
11059 @end smallexample
11060
11061 @noindent
11062 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11063 completely specified.
11064
11065 @kindex info types
11066 @item info types @var{regexp}
11067 @itemx info types
11068 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11069 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11070 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11071 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11072 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11073 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11074 name is @code{value}.
11075
11076 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11077 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11078 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11079
11080 @kindex info scope
11081 @cindex local variables
11082 @item info scope @var{location}
11083 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11084 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11085 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11086 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11087 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11088
11089 @smallexample
11090 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11091 Scope for command_line_handler:
11092 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11093 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11094 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11095 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11096 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11097 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11098 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11099 @end smallexample
11100
11101 @noindent
11102 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11103 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11104 collect}.
11105
11106 @kindex info source
11107 @item info source
11108 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11109 the function containing the current point of execution:
11110 @itemize @bullet
11111 @item
11112 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11113 @item
11114 the directory it was compiled in,
11115 @item
11116 its length, in lines,
11117 @item
11118 which programming language it is written in,
11119 @item
11120 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11121 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11122 @item
11123 whether the debugging information includes information about
11124 preprocessor macros.
11125 @end itemize
11126
11127
11128 @kindex info sources
11129 @item info sources
11130 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11131 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11132 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11133
11134 @kindex info functions
11135 @item info functions
11136 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11137
11138 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11139 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11140 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11141 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11142 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11143 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11144 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11145 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11146
11147 @kindex info variables
11148 @item info variables
11149 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11150 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11151
11152 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11153 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11154 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11155 @var{regexp}.
11156
11157 @kindex info classes
11158 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11159 @item info classes
11160 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11161 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11162 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11163 expression.
11164
11165 @kindex info selectors
11166 @item info selectors
11167 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11168 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11169 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11170 expression.
11171
11172 @ignore
11173 This was never implemented.
11174 @kindex info methods
11175 @item info methods
11176 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11177 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11178 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11179 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11180 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11181 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11182 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11183 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11184 @end ignore
11185
11186 @cindex reloading symbols
11187 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11188 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11189 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11190 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11191 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11192
11193 @table @code
11194 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11195 @item set symbol-reloading on
11196 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11197 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11198
11199 @item set symbol-reloading off
11200 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11201 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11202 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11203 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11204 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11205 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11206 name.
11207
11208 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11209 @item show symbol-reloading
11210 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @cindex opaque data types
11214 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11215 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11216 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11217 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11218 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11219 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11220 another source file. The default is on.
11221
11222 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11223 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11224
11225 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11226 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11227 is printed as follows:
11228 @smallexample
11229 @{<no data fields>@}
11230 @end smallexample
11231
11232 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11233 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11234 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11235
11236 @kindex maint print symbols
11237 @cindex symbol dump
11238 @kindex maint print psymbols
11239 @cindex partial symbol dump
11240 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11241 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11242 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11243 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11244 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11245 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11246 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11247 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11248 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11249 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11250 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11251 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11252 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11253 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11254 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11255 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11256 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11257
11258 @kindex maint info symtabs
11259 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11260 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11261 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11262 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11263 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11264 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11265 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11266
11267 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11268 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11269 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11270 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11271 structure in more detail. For example:
11272
11273 @smallexample
11274 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11275 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11276 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11277 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11278 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11279 readin no
11280 fullname (null)
11281 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11282 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11283 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11284 dependencies (none)
11285 @}
11286 @}
11287 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11288 (@value{GDBP})
11289 @end smallexample
11290 @noindent
11291 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11292 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11293 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11294 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11295 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11296
11297 @smallexample
11298 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11299 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11300 line 1574.
11301 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11302 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11303 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11304 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11305 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11306 dirname (null)
11307 fullname (null)
11308 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11309 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11310 debugformat DWARF 2
11311 @}
11312 @}
11313 (@value{GDBP})
11314 @end smallexample
11315 @end table
11316
11317
11318 @node Altering
11319 @chapter Altering Execution
11320
11321 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11322 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11323 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11324 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11325 program.
11326
11327 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11328 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11329 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11330
11331 @menu
11332 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11333 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11334 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11335 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11336 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11337 * Patching:: Patching your program
11338 @end menu
11339
11340 @node Assignment
11341 @section Assignment to Variables
11342
11343 @cindex assignment
11344 @cindex setting variables
11345 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11346 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11347
11348 @smallexample
11349 print x=4
11350 @end smallexample
11351
11352 @noindent
11353 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11354 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11355 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11356 information on operators in supported languages.
11357
11358 @kindex set variable
11359 @cindex variables, setting
11360 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11361 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11362 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11363 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11364 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11365
11366 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11367 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11368 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11369 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11370 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11371 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11372 command @code{set width}:
11373
11374 @smallexample
11375 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11376 type = double
11377 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11378 $4 = 13
11379 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11380 Invalid syntax in expression.
11381 @end smallexample
11382
11383 @noindent
11384 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11385 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11386
11387 @smallexample
11388 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11389 @end smallexample
11390
11391 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11392 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11393 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11394 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11395 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11396 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11397
11398 @smallexample
11399 @group
11400 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11401 type = double
11402 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11403 $1 = 1
11404 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11405 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11406 $2 = 1
11407 (@value{GDBP}) r
11408 The program being debugged has been started already.
11409 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11410 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11411 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11412 Invalid bfd target.
11413 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11414 The current BFD target is "=4".
11415 @end group
11416 @end smallexample
11417
11418 @noindent
11419 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11420 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11421 @code{g}, use
11422
11423 @smallexample
11424 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11425 @end smallexample
11426
11427 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11428 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11429 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11430 same length or shorter.
11431 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11432 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11433
11434 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11435 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11436 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11437 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11438 and representation in memory), and
11439
11440 @smallexample
11441 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11442 @end smallexample
11443
11444 @noindent
11445 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11446
11447 @node Jumping
11448 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11449
11450 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11451 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11452 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11453
11454 @table @code
11455 @kindex jump
11456 @item jump @var{linespec}
11457 @itemx jump @var{location}
11458 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11459 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11460 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11461 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11462 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11463 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11464
11465 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11466 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11467 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11468 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11469 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11470 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11471 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11472 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11473 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11474 @end table
11475
11476 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11477 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11478 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11479 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11480 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11481 example,
11482
11483 @smallexample
11484 set $pc = 0x485
11485 @end smallexample
11486
11487 @noindent
11488 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11489 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11490 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11491
11492 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11493 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11494 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11495 detail.
11496
11497 @c @group
11498 @node Signaling
11499 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11500 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11501
11502 @table @code
11503 @kindex signal
11504 @item signal @var{signal}
11505 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11506 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11507 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11508 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11509
11510 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11511 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11512 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11513 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11514 signal.
11515
11516 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11517 after executing the command.
11518 @end table
11519 @c @end group
11520
11521 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11522 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11523 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11524 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11525 passes the signal directly to your program.
11526
11527
11528 @node Returning
11529 @section Returning from a Function
11530
11531 @table @code
11532 @cindex returning from a function
11533 @kindex return
11534 @item return
11535 @itemx return @var{expression}
11536 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11537 command. If you give an
11538 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11539 value.
11540 @end table
11541
11542 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11543 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11544 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11545 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11546
11547 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11548 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11549 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11550 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11551 of functions.
11552
11553 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11554 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11555 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11556 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11557 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11558
11559 @node Calling
11560 @section Calling Program Functions
11561
11562 @table @code
11563 @cindex calling functions
11564 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11565 @item print @var{expr}
11566 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11567 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11568 debugged.
11569
11570 @kindex call
11571 @item call @var{expr}
11572 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11573 returned values.
11574
11575 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11576 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11577 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11578 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11579 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11580 value history.
11581 @end table
11582
11583 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11584 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11585 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11586 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11587
11588 @table @code
11589 @item set unwindonsignal
11590 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11591 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11592 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11593 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11594 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11595 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11596 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11597 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11598 received.
11599
11600 @item show unwindonsignal
11601 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11602 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11603 @value{GDBN}.
11604 @end table
11605
11606 @cindex weak alias functions
11607 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11608 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11609 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11610 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11611 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11612 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11613 function instead.
11614
11615 @node Patching
11616 @section Patching Programs
11617
11618 @cindex patching binaries
11619 @cindex writing into executables
11620 @cindex writing into corefiles
11621
11622 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11623 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11624 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11625 patching your program's binary.
11626
11627 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11628 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11629 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11630 repairs.
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @kindex set write
11634 @item set write on
11635 @itemx set write off
11636 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11637 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11638 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11639
11640 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11641 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11642 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11643
11644 @item show write
11645 @kindex show write
11646 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11647 as well as reading.
11648 @end table
11649
11650 @node GDB Files
11651 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11652
11653 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11654 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11655 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11656 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11657
11658 @menu
11659 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11660 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11661 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11662 @end menu
11663
11664 @node Files
11665 @section Commands to Specify Files
11666
11667 @cindex symbol table
11668 @cindex core dump file
11669
11670 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11671 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11672 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11673 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11674
11675 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11676 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11677 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11678 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11679 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11680 new files are useful.
11681
11682 @table @code
11683 @cindex executable file
11684 @kindex file
11685 @item file @var{filename}
11686 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11687 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11688 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11689 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11690 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11691 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11692 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11693 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11694
11695 @cindex unlinked object files
11696 @cindex patching object files
11697 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11698 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11699 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11700 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11701 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11702 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11703 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11704 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11705
11706 @item file
11707 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11708 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11709
11710 @kindex exec-file
11711 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11712 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11713 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11714 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11715 discard information on the executable file.
11716
11717 @kindex symbol-file
11718 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11719 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11720 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11721 table and program to run from the same file.
11722
11723 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11724 program's symbol table.
11725
11726 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11727 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11728 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11729 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11730 @value{GDBN}.
11731
11732 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11733 executing it once.
11734
11735 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11736 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11737 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11738 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11739 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11740 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11741 optimized code.
11742
11743 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11744 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11745 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11746 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11747 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11748
11749 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11750 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11751 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11752 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11753 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11754 Warnings and Messages}.)
11755
11756 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11757 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11758 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11759 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11760 in stabs format.
11761
11762 @kindex readnow
11763 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11764 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11765 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11766 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11767 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11768 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11769 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11770 entire symbol table available.
11771
11772 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11773 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11774 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11775 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11776 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11777 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11778 @c files.
11779
11780 @kindex core-file
11781 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11782 @itemx core
11783 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11784 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11785 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11786 executable file itself for other parts.
11787
11788 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11789 to be used.
11790
11791 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11792 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11793 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11794 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11795 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11796
11797 @kindex add-symbol-file
11798 @cindex dynamic linking
11799 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11800 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11801 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11802 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11803 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11804 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11805 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11806 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11807 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11808 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11809 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11810 @var{address} as an expression.
11811
11812 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11813 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11814 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11815 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11816 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11817
11818 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11819 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11820 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11821 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11822 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11823 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11824 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11825 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11826 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11827
11828 @itemize @bullet
11829 @item
11830 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11831 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11832 @item
11833 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11834 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11835 @item
11836 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11837 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11838 @end itemize
11839
11840 @noindent
11841 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11842 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11843 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11844 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11845 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11846 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11847 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11848 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11849 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11850 way.
11851
11852 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11853
11854 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11855 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11856 @cindex load symbols from memory
11857 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11858 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11859 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11860 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11861 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11862 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11863 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11864 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11865 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11866
11867 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11868 @kindex assf
11869 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11870 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11871 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11872 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11873 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11874 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11875 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11876 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11877 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11878 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11879
11880 @kindex section
11881 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11882 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11883 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11884 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11885 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11886 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11887 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11888 their addresses.
11889
11890 @kindex info files
11891 @kindex info target
11892 @item info files
11893 @itemx info target
11894 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11895 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11896 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11897 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11898 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11899 current ones.
11900
11901 @kindex maint info sections
11902 @item maint info sections
11903 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11904 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11905 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11906 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11907 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11908 may be arbitrarily combined):
11909
11910 @table @code
11911 @item ALLOBJ
11912 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11913 @item @var{sections}
11914 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11915 @item @var{section-flags}
11916 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11917 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11918 @table @code
11919 @item ALLOC
11920 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11921 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11922 @item LOAD
11923 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11924 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11925 @item RELOC
11926 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11927 @item READONLY
11928 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11929 @item CODE
11930 Section contains executable code only.
11931 @item DATA
11932 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11933 @item ROM
11934 Section will reside in ROM.
11935 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11936 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11937 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11938 Section is not empty.
11939 @item NEVER_LOAD
11940 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11941 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11942 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11943 COFF shared library information.
11944 @item IS_COMMON
11945 Section contains common symbols.
11946 @end table
11947 @end table
11948 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11949 @cindex read-only sections
11950 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11951 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11952 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11953 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11954 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11955 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11956 enhancement to debugging performance.
11957
11958 The default is off.
11959
11960 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11961 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11962 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11963 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11964
11965 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11966 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11967 @end table
11968
11969 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11970 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11971 name and remembers it that way.
11972
11973 @cindex shared libraries
11974 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11975 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11976 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11977
11978 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11979 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11980
11981 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11982 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11983 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11984 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11985 debugging a core file).
11986
11987 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11988 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11989
11990 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11991 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11992 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11993
11994 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11995 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11996 particularly large or there are many of them.
11997
11998 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11999 commands:
12000
12001 @table @code
12002 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12003 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12004 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12005 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12006 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12007 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12008 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12009 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12010
12011 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12012 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12013 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12014 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12015 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12016 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12017 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12018 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12019 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12020
12021 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12022 @item show auto-solib-add
12023 Display the current autoloading mode.
12024 @end table
12025
12026 @cindex load shared library
12027 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12028 command:
12029
12030 @table @code
12031 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12032 @kindex info share
12033 @item info share
12034 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12035 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12036
12037 @kindex sharedlibrary
12038 @kindex share
12039 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12040 @itemx share @var{regex}
12041 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12042 Unix regular expression.
12043 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12044 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12045 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12046 loaded.
12047
12048 @item nosharedlibrary
12049 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12050 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12051 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12052 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12053 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12054 discarded.
12055 @end table
12056
12057 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12058 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12059 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12060
12061 @table @code
12062 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12063 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12064 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12065 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12066 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12067 shared library.
12068
12069 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12070 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12071 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12072 library events happen.
12073 @end table
12074
12075 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12076 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12077 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12078 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12079 not.
12080
12081 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12082 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12083 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12084 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12085 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12086
12087 @table @code
12088 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12089 @cindex system root, alternate
12090 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12091 @kindex set sysroot
12092 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12093 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12094 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12095 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12096 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12097 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12098 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12099 under @var{path}.
12100
12101 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12102 sysroot}.
12103
12104 @cindex default system root
12105 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12106 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12107 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12108 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12109 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12110 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12111 location.
12112
12113 @kindex show sysroot
12114 @item show sysroot
12115 Display the current shared library prefix.
12116
12117 @kindex set solib-search-path
12118 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12119 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12120 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12121 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12122 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12123 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12124 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12125 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12126 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12127 of shared library symbols.
12128
12129 @kindex show solib-search-path
12130 @item show solib-search-path
12131 Display the current shared library search path.
12132 @end table
12133
12134
12135 @node Separate Debug Files
12136 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12137 @cindex separate debugging information files
12138 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12139 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12140 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12141 @cindex global debugging information directory
12142 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12143 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12144
12145 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12146 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12147 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12148 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12149 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12150 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12151 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12152
12153 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12154 file:
12155
12156 @itemize @bullet
12157 @item
12158 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12159 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12160 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12161 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12162 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12163 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12164 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12165 came from the same build.
12166
12167 @item
12168 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12169 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12170 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12171 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12172 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12173 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12174 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12175 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12176 below.
12177 @end itemize
12178
12179 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12180 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12181
12182 @itemize @bullet
12183 @item
12184 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12185 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12186 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12187 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12188 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12189
12190 @item
12191 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12192 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12193 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12194 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12195 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12196 hex characters, not 10.)
12197 @end itemize
12198
12199 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12200 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12201 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12202 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12203 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12204 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12205
12206 @itemize @minus
12207 @item
12208 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12209 @item
12210 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12211 @item
12212 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12213 @item
12214 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12215 @end itemize
12216
12217 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12218 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12219
12220 @table @code
12221
12222 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12223 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12224 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12225 information files to @var{directory}.
12226
12227 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12228 @item show debug-file-directory
12229 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12230 information files.
12231
12232 @end table
12233
12234 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12235 @cindex debug link sections
12236 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12237 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12238
12239 @itemize
12240 @item
12241 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12242 a zero byte,
12243 @item
12244 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12245 boundary within the section, and
12246 @item
12247 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12248 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12249 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12250 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12251 @end itemize
12252
12253 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12254 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12255 described above.
12256
12257 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12258 @cindex build ID sections
12259 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12260 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12261 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12262 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12263 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12264 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12265 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12266 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12267 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12268
12269 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12270 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12271 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12272 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12273 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12274 in an ordinary executable.
12275
12276 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12277 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12278 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12279 following commands:
12280
12281 @smallexample
12282 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12283 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12284 @end smallexample
12285
12286 @noindent
12287 These commands remove the debugging
12288 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12289 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12290 two files:
12291
12292 @itemize @bullet
12293 @item
12294 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12295 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12299 @end smallexample
12300
12301 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12302 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12303 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12304 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12305
12306 @item
12307 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12308 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12309 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12310 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12311 @end itemize
12312
12313 @noindent
12314
12315 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12316 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12317 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12318 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12319
12320 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12321 @smallexample
12322 unsigned long
12323 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12324 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12325 @{
12326 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12327 @{
12328 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12329 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12330 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12331 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12332 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12333 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12334 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12335 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12336 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12337 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12338 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12339 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12340 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12341 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12342 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12343 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12344 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12345 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12346 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12347 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12348 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12349 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12350 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12351 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12352 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12353 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12354 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12355 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12356 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12357 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12358 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12359 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12360 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12361 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12362 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12363 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12364 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12365 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12366 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12367 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12368 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12369 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12370 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12371 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12372 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12373 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12374 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12375 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12376 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12377 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12378 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12379 0x2d02ef8d
12380 @};
12381 unsigned char *end;
12382
12383 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12384 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12385 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12386 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12387 @}
12388 @end smallexample
12389
12390 @noindent
12391 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12392
12393
12394 @node Symbol Errors
12395 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12396
12397 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12398 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12399 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12400 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12401 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12402 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12403 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12404 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12405 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12406 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12407 Messages}).
12408
12409 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12410
12411 @table @code
12412 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12413
12414 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12415 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12416 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12417 in its outer scope blocks.
12418
12419 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12420 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12421 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12422 function.
12423
12424 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12425
12426 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12427 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12428 do so.
12429
12430 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12431 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12432 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12433 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12434 Messages}.)
12435
12436 @item bad block start address patched
12437
12438 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12439 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12440 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12441
12442 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12443 starting on the previous source line.
12444
12445 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12446
12447 @cindex foo
12448 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12449 larger than the size of the string table.
12450
12451 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12452 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12453 with this name.
12454
12455 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12456
12457 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12458 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12459 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12460
12461 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12462 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12463 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12464 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12465 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12466 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12467
12468 @item stub type has NULL name
12469
12470 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12471
12472 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12473 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12474 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12475 it.
12476
12477 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12478
12479 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12480
12481 @end table
12482
12483 @node Targets
12484 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12485
12486 @cindex debugging target
12487 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12488
12489 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12490 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12491 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12492 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12493 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12494 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12495 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12496 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12497
12498 @cindex target architecture
12499 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12500 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12501 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12502 command.
12503
12504 @table @code
12505 @kindex set architecture
12506 @kindex show architecture
12507 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12508 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12509 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12510 supported architectures.
12511
12512 @item show architecture
12513 Show the current target architecture.
12514
12515 @item set processor
12516 @itemx processor
12517 @kindex set processor
12518 @kindex show processor
12519 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12520 and @code{show architecture}.
12521 @end table
12522
12523 @menu
12524 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12525 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12526 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12527 @end menu
12528
12529 @node Active Targets
12530 @section Active Targets
12531
12532 @cindex stacking targets
12533 @cindex active targets
12534 @cindex multiple targets
12535
12536 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12537 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12538 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12539 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12540 a core file.
12541
12542 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12543 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12544 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12545 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12546 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12547 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12548 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12549 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12550 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12551
12552 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12553 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12554 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12555 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12556 process target is active.
12557
12558 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12559 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12560 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12561 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12562 Process}).
12563
12564 @node Target Commands
12565 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12566
12567 @table @code
12568 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12569 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12570 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12571 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12572 protocol of the target machine.
12573
12574 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12575 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12576 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12577
12578 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12579 after executing the command.
12580
12581 @kindex help target
12582 @item help target
12583 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12584 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12585 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12586
12587 @item help target @var{name}
12588 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12589 select it.
12590
12591 @kindex set gnutarget
12592 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12593 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12594 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12595 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12596 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12597 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12598
12599 @quotation
12600 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12601 you must know the actual BFD name.
12602 @end quotation
12603
12604 @noindent
12605 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12606
12607 @kindex show gnutarget
12608 @item show gnutarget
12609 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12610 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12611 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12612 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12613 @end table
12614
12615 @cindex common targets
12616 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12617 configuration):
12618
12619 @table @code
12620 @kindex target
12621 @item target exec @var{program}
12622 @cindex executable file target
12623 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12624 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12625
12626 @item target core @var{filename}
12627 @cindex core dump file target
12628 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12629 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12630
12631 @item target remote @var{medium}
12632 @cindex remote target
12633 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12634 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12635 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12636
12637 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12638 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12639
12640 @smallexample
12641 target remote /dev/ttya
12642 @end smallexample
12643
12644 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12645 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12646 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12647 clobbered by the download.
12648
12649 @item target sim
12650 @cindex built-in simulator target
12651 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12652 In general,
12653 @smallexample
12654 target sim
12655 load
12656 run
12657 @end smallexample
12658 @noindent
12659 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12660 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12661 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12662 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12663 Processors}.
12664
12665 @end table
12666
12667 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12668
12669 @table @code
12670
12671 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12672 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12673 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12674
12675 @end table
12676
12677 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12678 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12679
12680 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12681 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12682 various aspects of this process.
12683
12684 @table @code
12685
12686 @item set hash
12687 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12688 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12689 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12690 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12691 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12692 monitor.
12693
12694 @item show hash
12695 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12696 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12697
12698 @item set debug monitor
12699 @kindex set debug monitor
12700 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12701 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12702 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12703
12704 @item show debug monitor
12705 @kindex show debug monitor
12706 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12707 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12708 @end table
12709
12710 @table @code
12711
12712 @kindex load @var{filename}
12713 @item load @var{filename}
12714 @anchor{load}
12715 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12716 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12717 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12718 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12719 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12720 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12721
12722 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12723 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12724 target is @dots{}}''
12725
12726 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12727 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12728 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12729 specifies a fixed address.
12730 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12731
12732 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12733 load programs into flash memory.
12734
12735 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12736 @end table
12737
12738 @node Byte Order
12739 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12740
12741 @cindex choosing target byte order
12742 @cindex target byte order
12743
12744 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12745 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12746 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12747 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12748 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12749 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12750
12751 @table @code
12752 @kindex set endian
12753 @item set endian big
12754 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12755
12756 @item set endian little
12757 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12758
12759 @item set endian auto
12760 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12761 executable.
12762
12763 @item show endian
12764 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12765
12766 @end table
12767
12768 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12769 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12770 target system.
12771
12772
12773 @node Remote Debugging
12774 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12775 @cindex remote debugging
12776
12777 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12778 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12779 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12780 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12781 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12782
12783 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12784 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12785 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12786 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12787 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12788 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12789
12790 Other remote targets may be available in your
12791 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12792
12793 @menu
12794 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12795 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12796 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12797 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12798 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12799 @end menu
12800
12801 @node Connecting
12802 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12803
12804 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12805 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12806 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12807 program as the first argument.
12808
12809 @cindex @code{target remote}
12810 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12811 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12812 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12813 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12814 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12815 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12816
12817 @table @code
12818
12819 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12820 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12821 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12822 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12823
12824 @smallexample
12825 target remote /dev/ttyb
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12829 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12830 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12831 @code{target} command.
12832
12833 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12834 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12835 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12836 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12837 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12838 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12839 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12840 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12841 target.
12842
12843 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12844 @code{manyfarms}:
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 target remote manyfarms:2828
12848 @end smallexample
12849
12850 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12851 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12852 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12853 port 1234 on your local machine:
12854
12855 @smallexample
12856 target remote :1234
12857 @end smallexample
12858 @noindent
12859
12860 Note that the colon is still required here.
12861
12862 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12863 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12864 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12865 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12866
12867 @smallexample
12868 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12869 @end smallexample
12870
12871 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12872 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12873 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12874 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12875
12876 @item target remote | @var{command}
12877 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12878 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12879 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12880 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12881 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12882 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12883 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12884 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12885
12886 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12887 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12888 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12889
12890 @end table
12891
12892 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12893 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
12894 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
12895 need to use @kbd{run}.
12896
12897 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12898 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12899 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12900 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12901 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12902 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12903 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12904
12905 @smallexample
12906 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12907 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12908 @end smallexample
12909
12910 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12911 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12912 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12913 goes back to waiting.
12914
12915 @table @code
12916 @kindex detach (remote)
12917 @item detach
12918 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12919 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12920 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12921 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12922 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12923
12924 @kindex disconnect
12925 @item disconnect
12926 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12927 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12928 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12929 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12930 another target.
12931
12932 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12933 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12934 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12935 @kindex monitor
12936 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12937 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12938 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12939 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12940 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12941 and implement.
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node File Transfer
12945 @section Sending files to a remote system
12946 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12947 @cindex file transfer
12948 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12949
12950 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12951 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12952 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12953 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12954 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12955 the only way to upload or download files.
12956
12957 Not all remote targets support these commands.
12958
12959 @table @code
12960 @kindex remote put
12961 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12962 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12963 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12964
12965 @kindex remote get
12966 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12967 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12968 on the host system.
12969
12970 @kindex remote delete
12971 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12972 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12973
12974 @end table
12975
12976 @node Server
12977 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12978
12979 @kindex gdbserver
12980 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12981 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12982 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12983 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12984
12985 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12986 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12987 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12988 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12989 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12990 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12991 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12992 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12993 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12994 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12995 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12996 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12997 choice for debugging.
12998
12999 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13000 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13001 protocol.
13002
13003 @quotation
13004 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13005 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13006 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13007 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13008 @code{gdbserver}.
13009 @end quotation
13010
13011 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13012 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13013
13014 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13015 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13016 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13017 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13018 system does all the symbol handling.
13019
13020 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13021 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13022 syntax is:
13023
13024 @smallexample
13025 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13026 @end smallexample
13027
13028 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13029 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13030 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13031 @file{/dev/com1}:
13032
13033 @smallexample
13034 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13035 @end smallexample
13036
13037 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13038 with it.
13039
13040 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13041
13042 @smallexample
13043 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13044 @end smallexample
13045
13046 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13047 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13048 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13049 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13050 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13051 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13052 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13053 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13054 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13055 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13056 @code{target remote} command.
13057
13058 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13059
13060 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13061 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13062
13063 @smallexample
13064 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13065 @end smallexample
13066
13067 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13068 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13069
13070 @pindex pidof
13071 @cindex attach to a program by name
13072 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13073 @code{pidof} utility:
13074
13075 @smallexample
13076 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13077 @end smallexample
13078
13079 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13080 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13081 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13082
13083 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13084 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13085 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13086
13087 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13088 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13089 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13090 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13091
13092 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13093 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13094 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13095 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13096 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13097 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13098 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13099 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13100 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13101
13102 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13103 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13104 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13105 the program you want to debug.
13106
13107 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13108 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13109 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13110
13111 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13112
13113 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13114 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13115 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13116 for bug reports to the developers.
13117
13118 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13119 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13120 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13121 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13122
13123 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13124 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13125 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13126 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13127
13128 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13129 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13130 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13131 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13132
13133 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13134 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13135 environment:
13136
13137 @smallexample
13138 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13139 @end smallexample
13140
13141 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13142
13143 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13144
13145 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13146 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13147 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13148 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13149
13150 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13151 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13152 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13153 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13154 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13155 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13156 programs.
13157
13158 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13159 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13160 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13161 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13162 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13163 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13164 already on the target.
13165
13166 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13167 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13168 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13169
13170 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13171 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13172 Here are the available commands.
13173
13174 @table @code
13175 @item monitor help
13176 List the available monitor commands.
13177
13178 @item monitor set debug 0
13179 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13180 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13181
13182 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13183 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13184 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13185 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13186
13187 @item monitor exit
13188 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13189 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13190 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13191 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13192 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13193
13194 @end table
13195
13196 @node Remote Configuration
13197 @section Remote Configuration
13198
13199 @kindex set remote
13200 @kindex show remote
13201 This section documents the configuration options available when
13202 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13203 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13204 system-call-allowed}.
13205
13206 @table @code
13207 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13208 @cindex address size for remote targets
13209 @cindex bits in remote address
13210 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13211 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13212 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13213 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13214
13215 @item show remoteaddresssize
13216 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13217
13218 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13219 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13220 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13221 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13222 remote targets.
13223
13224 @item show remotebaud
13225 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13226
13227 @item set remotebreak
13228 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13229 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13230 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13231 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13232 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13233 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13234 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13235 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13236
13237 @item show remotebreak
13238 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13239 interrupt the remote program.
13240
13241 @item set remoteflow on
13242 @itemx set remoteflow off
13243 @kindex set remoteflow
13244 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13245 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13246
13247 @item show remoteflow
13248 @kindex show remoteflow
13249 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13250
13251 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13252 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13253 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13254 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13255 @code{ascii}.
13256
13257 @item show remotelogbase
13258 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13259 protocol.
13260
13261 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13262 @cindex record serial communications on file
13263 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13264 default is not to record at all.
13265
13266 @item show remotelogfile.
13267 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13268 serial communications.
13269
13270 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13271 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13272 @cindex remote timeout
13273 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13274 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13275
13276 @item show remotetimeout
13277 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13278 responses.
13279
13280 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13281 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13282 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13283 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13284 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13285 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13286 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13287 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13288
13289 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13290 @itemx show remote exec-file
13291 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13292 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13293 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13294 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13295 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13296 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13297 @end table
13298
13299 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13300 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13301 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13302 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13303 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13304 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13305 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13306 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13307 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13308
13309 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13310 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13311 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13312 @value{GDBN} developers.
13313
13314 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13315 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13316 are:
13317
13318 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13319 @item Command Name
13320 @tab Remote Packet
13321 @tab Related Features
13322
13323 @item @code{fetch-register}
13324 @tab @code{p}
13325 @tab @code{info registers}
13326
13327 @item @code{set-register}
13328 @tab @code{P}
13329 @tab @code{set}
13330
13331 @item @code{binary-download}
13332 @tab @code{X}
13333 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13334
13335 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13336 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13337 @tab @code{info auxv}
13338
13339 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13340 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13341 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13342
13343 @item @code{attach}
13344 @tab @code{vAttach}
13345 @tab @code{attach}
13346
13347 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13348 @tab @code{vCont}
13349 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13350
13351 @item @code{run}
13352 @tab @code{vRun}
13353 @tab @code{run}
13354
13355 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13356 @tab @code{Z0}
13357 @tab @code{break}
13358
13359 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13360 @tab @code{Z1}
13361 @tab @code{hbreak}
13362
13363 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13364 @tab @code{Z2}
13365 @tab @code{watch}
13366
13367 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13368 @tab @code{Z3}
13369 @tab @code{rwatch}
13370
13371 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13372 @tab @code{Z4}
13373 @tab @code{awatch}
13374
13375 @item @code{target-features}
13376 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13377 @tab @code{set architecture}
13378
13379 @item @code{library-info}
13380 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13381 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13382
13383 @item @code{memory-map}
13384 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13385 @tab @code{info mem}
13386
13387 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13388 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13389 @tab @code{info spu}
13390
13391 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13392 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13393 @tab @code{info spu}
13394
13395 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13396 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13397 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13398
13399 @item @code{supported-packets}
13400 @tab @code{qSupported}
13401 @tab Remote communications parameters
13402
13403 @item @code{pass-signals}
13404 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13405 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13406
13407 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13408 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13409 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13410
13411 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13412 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13413 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13414
13415 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13416 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13417 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13418
13419 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13420 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13421 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13422
13423 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13424 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13425 @tab @code{remote delete}
13426 @end multitable
13427
13428 @node Remote Stub
13429 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13430
13431 @cindex debugging stub, example
13432 @cindex remote stub, example
13433 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13434 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13435 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13436 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13437 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13438 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13439 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13440 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13441
13442 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13443 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13444 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13445 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13446 program, you need:
13447
13448 @enumerate
13449 @item
13450 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13451 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13452 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13453
13454 @item
13455 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13456 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13457
13458 @item
13459 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13460 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13461 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13462 documentation.
13463 @end enumerate
13464
13465 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13466 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13467 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13468
13469 @table @emph
13470 @item On the host,
13471 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13472 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13473 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13474
13475 @item On the target,
13476 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13477 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13478 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13479
13480 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13481 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13482 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13483 @end table
13484
13485 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13486 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13487 @sc{sparc} boards.
13488
13489 @cindex remote serial stub list
13490 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13491
13492 @table @code
13493
13494 @item i386-stub.c
13495 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13496 @cindex Intel
13497 @cindex i386
13498 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13499
13500 @item m68k-stub.c
13501 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13502 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13503 @cindex m680x0
13504 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13505
13506 @item sh-stub.c
13507 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13508 @cindex Renesas
13509 @cindex SH
13510 For Renesas SH architectures.
13511
13512 @item sparc-stub.c
13513 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13514 @cindex Sparc
13515 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13516
13517 @item sparcl-stub.c
13518 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13519 @cindex Fujitsu
13520 @cindex SparcLite
13521 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13522
13523 @end table
13524
13525 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13526 recently added stubs.
13527
13528 @menu
13529 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13530 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13531 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13532 @end menu
13533
13534 @node Stub Contents
13535 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13536
13537 @cindex remote serial stub
13538 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13539 subroutines:
13540
13541 @table @code
13542 @item set_debug_traps
13543 @findex set_debug_traps
13544 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13545 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13546 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13547 beginning of your program.
13548
13549 @item handle_exception
13550 @findex handle_exception
13551 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13552 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13553 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13554 run when a trap is triggered.
13555
13556 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13557 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13558 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13559 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13560 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13561 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13562 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13563 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13564 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13565 machine.
13566
13567 @item breakpoint
13568 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13569 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13570 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13571 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13572 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13573 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13574 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13575 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13576 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13577 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13578 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13579
13580 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13581 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13582 start of your debugging session.
13583 @end table
13584
13585 @node Bootstrapping
13586 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13587
13588 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13589 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13590 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13591 debugging target machine.
13592
13593 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13594 serial port.
13595
13596 @table @code
13597 @item int getDebugChar()
13598 @findex getDebugChar
13599 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13600 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13601 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13602
13603 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13604 @findex putDebugChar
13605 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13606 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13607 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13608 @end table
13609
13610 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13611 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13612 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13613 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13614 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13615 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13616 remote system to stop.
13617
13618 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13619 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13620 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13621 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13622
13623 Other routines you need to supply are:
13624
13625 @table @code
13626 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13627 @findex exceptionHandler
13628 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13629 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13630 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13631 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13632 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13633 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13634 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13635 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13636 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13637 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13638 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13639 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13640 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13641
13642 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13643 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13644 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13645 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13646 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13647
13648 @item void flush_i_cache()
13649 @findex flush_i_cache
13650 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13651 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13652 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13653
13654 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13655 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13656 @end table
13657
13658 @noindent
13659 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13660
13661 @table @code
13662 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13663 @findex memset
13664 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13665 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13666 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13667 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13668 @end table
13669
13670 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13671 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13672 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13673 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13674
13675
13676 @node Debug Session
13677 @subsection Putting it All Together
13678
13679 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13680 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13681 steps.
13682
13683 @enumerate
13684 @item
13685 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13686 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13687 @display
13688 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13689 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13690 @end display
13691
13692 @item
13693 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13694
13695 @smallexample
13696 set_debug_traps();
13697 breakpoint();
13698 @end smallexample
13699
13700 @item
13701 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13702 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13703
13704 @smallexample
13705 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13706 @end smallexample
13707
13708 @noindent
13709 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13710 function in your program, that function is called when
13711 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13712 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13713 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13714
13715 @item
13716 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13717 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13718
13719 @item
13720 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13721 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13722
13723 @item
13724 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13725 @c document that. FIXME.
13726 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13727 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13728
13729 @item
13730 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13731 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13732
13733 @end enumerate
13734
13735 @node Configurations
13736 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13737
13738 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13739 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13740 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13741
13742 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13743 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13744 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13745 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13746 are quite different from each other.
13747
13748 @menu
13749 * Native::
13750 * Embedded OS::
13751 * Embedded Processors::
13752 * Architectures::
13753 @end menu
13754
13755 @node Native
13756 @section Native
13757
13758 This section describes details specific to particular native
13759 configurations.
13760
13761 @menu
13762 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13763 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13764 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13765 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13766 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13767 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13768 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13769 @end menu
13770
13771 @node HP-UX
13772 @subsection HP-UX
13773
13774 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13775 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13776 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13777
13778
13779 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13780 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13781
13782 @cindex libkvm
13783 @cindex kernel memory image
13784 @cindex kernel crash dump
13785
13786 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13787 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13788 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13789 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13790 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13791 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13792 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13793 @code{kvm} target:
13794
13795 @smallexample
13796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13797 @end smallexample
13798
13799 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13800 argument:
13801
13802 @smallexample
13803 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13804 @end smallexample
13805
13806 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13807 available:
13808
13809 @table @code
13810 @kindex kvm
13811 @item kvm pcb
13812 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13813
13814 @item kvm proc
13815 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13816 modern FreeBSD systems.
13817 @end table
13818
13819 @node SVR4 Process Information
13820 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13821 @cindex /proc
13822 @cindex examine process image
13823 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13824
13825 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13826 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13827 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13828 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13829 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13830 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13831 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13832 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13833 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13834
13835 @table @code
13836 @kindex info proc
13837 @cindex process ID
13838 @item info proc
13839 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13840 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13841 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13842 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13843 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13844 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13845 executable file's absolute file name.
13846
13847 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13848 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13849 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13850 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13851 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13852 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13853
13854 @item info proc mappings
13855 @cindex memory address space mappings
13856 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13857 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13858 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13859 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13860 memory access rights to that range.
13861
13862 @item info proc stat
13863 @itemx info proc status
13864 @cindex process detailed status information
13865 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13866 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13867 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13868 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13869 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13870 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13871 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13872
13873 @item info proc all
13874 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13875 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13876
13877 @ignore
13878 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13879 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13880 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13881 @kindex info proc times
13882 @item info proc times
13883 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13884 its children.
13885
13886 @kindex info proc id
13887 @item info proc id
13888 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13889 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13890 @end ignore
13891
13892 @item set procfs-trace
13893 @kindex set procfs-trace
13894 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13895 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13896
13897 @item show procfs-trace
13898 @kindex show procfs-trace
13899 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13900
13901 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13902 @kindex set procfs-file
13903 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13904 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13905 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13906 standard output.
13907
13908 @item show procfs-file
13909 @kindex show procfs-file
13910 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13911
13912 @item proc-trace-entry
13913 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13914 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13915 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13916 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13917 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13918 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13919 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13920 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13921 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13922
13923 @item info pidlist
13924 @kindex info pidlist
13925 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13926 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13927 processes and all the threads within each process.
13928
13929 @item info meminfo
13930 @kindex info meminfo
13931 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13932 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13933 @end table
13934
13935 @node DJGPP Native
13936 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13937 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13938 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13939 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13940
13941 @cindex DPMI
13942 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13943 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13944 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13945 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13946
13947 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13948 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13949 subsection describes those commands.
13950
13951 @table @code
13952 @kindex info dos
13953 @item info dos
13954 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13955 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13956
13957 @kindex sysinfo
13958 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13959 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13960 @item info dos sysinfo
13961 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13962 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13963 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13964
13965 @cindex GDT
13966 @cindex LDT
13967 @cindex IDT
13968 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13969 @cindex descriptor tables display
13970 @item info dos gdt
13971 @itemx info dos ldt
13972 @itemx info dos idt
13973 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13974 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13975 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13976 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13977 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13978 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13979 rights.
13980
13981 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13982 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13983 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13984 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13985 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13986
13987 @cindex garbled pointers
13988 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13989 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13990 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13991 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13992 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13993 debugged program's data segment:
13994
13995 @smallexample
13996 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13997 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13998 @end smallexample
13999
14000 @noindent
14001 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14002 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14003
14004 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14005 @item info dos pde
14006 @itemx info dos pte
14007 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14008 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14009 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14010 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14011 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14012 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14013 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14014 that is currently in use.
14015
14016 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14017 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14018 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14019 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14020 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14021 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14022 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14023
14024 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14025 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14026 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14027 controller.
14028
14029 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14030
14031 @cindex physical address from linear address
14032 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14033 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14034 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14035 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14036 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14037 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14038 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14039
14040 @smallexample
14041 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14042 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14043 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14044 @end smallexample
14045
14046 @noindent
14047 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14048 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14049 attributes of that page.
14050
14051 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14052 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14053 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14054 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14055 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14056 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14057
14058 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14059 transfer buffer:
14060
14061 @smallexample
14062 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14063 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14064 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14065 @end smallexample
14066
14067 @noindent
14068 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14069 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14070 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14071 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14072 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14073
14074 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14075 @end table
14076
14077 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14078 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14079 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14080 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14081
14082 @table @code
14083 @kindex set com1base
14084 @kindex set com1irq
14085 @kindex set com2base
14086 @kindex set com2irq
14087 @kindex set com3base
14088 @kindex set com3irq
14089 @kindex set com4base
14090 @kindex set com4irq
14091 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14092 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14093 port.
14094
14095 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14096 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14097 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14098
14099 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14100 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14101 other 3 COM ports.
14102
14103 @kindex show com1base
14104 @kindex show com1irq
14105 @kindex show com2base
14106 @kindex show com2irq
14107 @kindex show com3base
14108 @kindex show com3irq
14109 @kindex show com4base
14110 @kindex show com4irq
14111 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14112 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14113 lines used by the COM ports.
14114
14115 @item info serial
14116 @kindex info serial
14117 @cindex DOS serial port status
14118 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14119 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14120 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14121 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14122 @end table
14123
14124
14125 @node Cygwin Native
14126 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14127 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14128 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14129 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14130
14131 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14132 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14133 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14134 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14135 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14136
14137 @table @code
14138 @kindex info w32
14139 @item info w32
14140 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14141 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14142
14143 @item info w32 selector
14144 This command displays information returned by
14145 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14146 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14147 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14148 Without argument, this command displays information
14149 about the six segment registers.
14150
14151 @kindex info dll
14152 @item info dll
14153 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14154
14155 @kindex dll-symbols
14156 @item dll-symbols
14157 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14158 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14159
14160 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14161 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14162 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14163 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14164 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14165 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14166 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14167 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14168 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14169 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14170 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14171
14172 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14173 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14174 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14175 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14176
14177 @kindex set new-console
14178 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14179 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14180 be started in a new console on next start.
14181 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14182 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14183
14184 @kindex show new-console
14185 @item show new-console
14186 Displays whether a new console is used
14187 when the debuggee is started.
14188
14189 @kindex set new-group
14190 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14191 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14192 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14193 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14194 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14195
14196 @kindex show new-group
14197 @item show new-group
14198 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14199
14200 @kindex set debugevents
14201 @item set debugevents
14202 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14203 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14204 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14205 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14206 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14207
14208 @kindex set debugexec
14209 @item set debugexec
14210 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14211 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14212
14213 @kindex set debugexceptions
14214 @item set debugexceptions
14215 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14216 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14217
14218 @kindex set debugmemory
14219 @item set debugmemory
14220 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14221 and writes by the debugger.
14222
14223 @kindex set shell
14224 @item set shell
14225 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14226 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14227
14228 @kindex show shell
14229 @item show shell
14230 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14231
14232 @end table
14233
14234 @menu
14235 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14236 @end menu
14237
14238 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14239 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14240 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14241 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14242
14243 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14244 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14245 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14246 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14247 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14248 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14249 ``minimal symbols''.
14250
14251 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14252 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14253 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14254 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14255 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14256 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14257 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14258 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14259 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14260 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14261
14262 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14263
14264 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14265 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14266 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14267 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14268 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14269 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14270 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14271 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14272 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14273
14274 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14275 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14276 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14277 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14278 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14279 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14280
14281 @smallexample
14282 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14283 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14284
14285 Non-debugging symbols:
14286 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14287 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14288 @end smallexample
14289
14290 @smallexample
14291 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14292 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14293
14294 Non-debugging symbols:
14295 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14296 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14297 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14298 [etc...]
14299 @end smallexample
14300
14301 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14302
14303 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14304 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14305 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14306 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14307 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14308 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14309 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14310
14311 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14312 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14313 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14314 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14315 problem:
14316
14317 @smallexample
14318 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14319 $1 = 268572168
14320 @end smallexample
14321
14322 @smallexample
14323 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14324 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 And two possible solutions:
14328
14329 @smallexample
14330 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14331 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14332 @end smallexample
14333
14334 @smallexample
14335 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14336 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14337 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14338 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14339 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14340 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14341 @end smallexample
14342
14343 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14344 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14345 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14346 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14347 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14348
14349 @smallexample
14350 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14351 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14352 @end smallexample
14353
14354 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14355 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14356 safe.
14357
14358 @node Hurd Native
14359 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14360 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14361
14362 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14363 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14364
14365 @table @code
14366 @item set signals
14367 @itemx set sigs
14368 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14369 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14370 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14371 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14372 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14373 @code{signals}.
14374
14375 @item show signals
14376 @itemx show sigs
14377 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14378 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14379 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14380
14381 @item set signal-thread
14382 @itemx set sigthread
14383 @kindex set signal-thread
14384 @kindex set sigthread
14385 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14386 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14387 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14388 signal-thread}.
14389
14390 @item show signal-thread
14391 @itemx show sigthread
14392 @kindex show signal-thread
14393 @kindex show sigthread
14394 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14395 delivered a signal.
14396
14397 @item set stopped
14398 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14399 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14400 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14401 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14402
14403 @item show stopped
14404 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14405 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14406 stopped.
14407
14408 @item set exceptions
14409 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14410 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14411 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14412 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14413 trapping on.
14414
14415 @item show exceptions
14416 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14417 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14418
14419 @item set task pause
14420 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14421 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14422 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14423 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14424 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14425 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14426 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14427 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14428 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14429
14430 @item show task pause
14431 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14432 Show the current state of task suspension.
14433
14434 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14435 @cindex task suspend count
14436 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14437 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14438 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14439
14440 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14441 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14442
14443 @item set task exception-port
14444 @itemx set task excp
14445 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14446 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14447 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14448 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14449
14450 @item set noninvasive
14451 @cindex noninvasive task options
14452 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14453 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14454 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14455 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14456
14457 @item info send-rights
14458 @itemx info receive-rights
14459 @itemx info port-rights
14460 @itemx info port-sets
14461 @itemx info dead-names
14462 @itemx info ports
14463 @itemx info psets
14464 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14465 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14466 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14467 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14468 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14469 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14470 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14471 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14472 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14473
14474 @item set thread pause
14475 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14476 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14477 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14478 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14479 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14480 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14481 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14482 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14483 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14484 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14485 only the current thread.
14486
14487 @item show thread pause
14488 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14489 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14490
14491 @item set thread run
14492 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14493
14494 @item show thread run
14495 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14496
14497 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14498 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14499 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14500 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14501 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14502 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14503 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14504
14505 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14506 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14507 detaching.
14508
14509 @item set thread exception-port
14510 @itemx set thread excp
14511 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14512 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14513 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14514
14515 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14516 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14517 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14518 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14519
14520 @item set thread default
14521 @itemx show thread default
14522 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14523 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14524 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14525 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14526 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14527 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14528 the non-default commands.
14529 @end table
14530
14531
14532 @node Neutrino
14533 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14534 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14535
14536 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14537 Neutrino target:
14538
14539 @table @code
14540 @item set debug nto-debug
14541 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14542 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14543 Neutrino support.
14544
14545 @item show debug nto-debug
14546 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14547 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14548 @end table
14549
14550
14551 @node Embedded OS
14552 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14553
14554 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14555 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14556 architectures.
14557
14558 @menu
14559 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14560 @end menu
14561
14562 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14563 various real-time operating systems.
14564
14565 @node VxWorks
14566 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14567
14568 @cindex VxWorks
14569
14570 @table @code
14571
14572 @kindex target vxworks
14573 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14574 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14575 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14576
14577 @end table
14578
14579 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14580 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14581
14582 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14583 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14584 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14585 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14586 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14587 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14588 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14589
14590 @table @code
14591 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14592 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14593 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14594 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14595 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14596 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14597 of a thin network line.
14598 @end table
14599
14600 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14601 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14602 procedures.
14603
14604 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14605 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14606 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14607 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14608 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14609 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14610 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14611 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14612 manual.
14613 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14614
14615 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14616 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14617 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14618 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14619
14620 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 (vxgdb)
14624 @end smallexample
14625
14626 @menu
14627 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14628 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14629 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14630 @end menu
14631
14632 @node VxWorks Connection
14633 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14634
14635 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14636 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14637
14638 @smallexample
14639 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14640 @end smallexample
14641
14642 @need 750
14643 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14644
14645 @smallexample
14646 Attaching remote machine across net...
14647 Connected to tt.
14648 @end smallexample
14649
14650 @need 1000
14651 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14652 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14653 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14654 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14655 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14656
14657 @smallexample
14658 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14659 @end smallexample
14660
14661 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14662 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14663 command again.
14664
14665 @node VxWorks Download
14666 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14667
14668 @cindex download to VxWorks
14669 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14670 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14671 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14672 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14673 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14674 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14675 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14676 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14677 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14678 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14679 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14680 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14681 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14682 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14683 program, type this on VxWorks:
14684
14685 @smallexample
14686 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14687 @end smallexample
14688
14689 @noindent
14690 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14691
14692 @smallexample
14693 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14694 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14695 @end smallexample
14696
14697 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14698
14699 @smallexample
14700 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14701 @end smallexample
14702
14703 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14704 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14705 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14706 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14707 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14708 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14709 table.)
14710
14711 @node VxWorks Attach
14712 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14713
14714 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14715 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14716 follows:
14717
14718 @smallexample
14719 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14720 @end smallexample
14721
14722 @noindent
14723 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14724 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14725 the time of attachment.
14726
14727 @node Embedded Processors
14728 @section Embedded Processors
14729
14730 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14731 configurations.
14732
14733 @cindex send command to simulator
14734 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14735 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14736
14737 @table @code
14738 @item sim @var{command}
14739 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14740 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14741 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14742 acceptable commands.
14743 @end table
14744
14745
14746 @menu
14747 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14748 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14749 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14750 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14751 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14752 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14753 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14754 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14755 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14756 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14757 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14758 * CRIS:: CRIS
14759 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14760 @end menu
14761
14762 @node ARM
14763 @subsection ARM
14764 @cindex ARM RDI
14765
14766 @table @code
14767 @kindex target rdi
14768 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14769 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14770 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14771 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14772
14773 @kindex target rdp
14774 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14775 ARM Demon monitor.
14776
14777 @end table
14778
14779 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14780
14781 @table @code
14782 @item set arm disassembler
14783 @kindex set arm
14784 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14785 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14786
14787 @item show arm disassembler
14788 @kindex show arm
14789 Show the current disassembly style.
14790
14791 @item set arm apcs32
14792 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14793 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14794
14795 @item show arm apcs32
14796 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14797
14798 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14799 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14800 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14801
14802 @table @code
14803 @item auto
14804 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14805 @item softfpa
14806 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14807 processors.
14808 @item fpa
14809 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14810 @item softvfp
14811 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14812 @item vfp
14813 VFP co-processor.
14814 @end table
14815
14816 @item show arm fpu
14817 Show the current type of the FPU.
14818
14819 @item set arm abi
14820 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14821
14822 @item show arm abi
14823 Show the currently used ABI.
14824
14825 @item set debug arm
14826 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14827 target support subsystem.
14828
14829 @item show debug arm
14830 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14831 @end table
14832
14833 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14834 using the RDI interface:
14835
14836 @table @code
14837 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14838 @kindex rdilogfile
14839 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14840 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14841 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14842 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14843 @file{rdi.log}.
14844
14845 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14846 @kindex rdilogenable
14847 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14848 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14849 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14850 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14851 are logged to a file.
14852
14853 @item set rdiromatzero
14854 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14855 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14856 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14857 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14858 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14859 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14860
14861 @item show rdiromatzero
14862 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14863 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14864
14865 @item set rdiheartbeat
14866 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14867 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14868 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14869 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14870 well as the Angel monitor.
14871
14872 @item show rdiheartbeat
14873 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14874 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14875 @end table
14876
14877
14878 @node M32R/D
14879 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14880
14881 @table @code
14882 @kindex target m32r
14883 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14884 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14885
14886 @kindex target m32rsdi
14887 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14888 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14889 @end table
14890
14891 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14892
14893 @table @code
14894 @item set download-path @var{path}
14895 @kindex set download-path
14896 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14897 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14898
14899 @item show download-path
14900 @kindex show download-path
14901 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14902
14903 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14904 @kindex set board-address
14905 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14906 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14907
14908 @item show board-address
14909 @kindex show board-address
14910 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14911
14912 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14913 @kindex set server-address
14914 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14915 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14916 host machine.
14917
14918 @item show server-address
14919 @kindex show server-address
14920 Display the IP address of the download server.
14921
14922 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14923 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14924 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14925 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14926 executable file is uploaded.
14927
14928 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14929 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14930 Test the @code{upload} command.
14931 @end table
14932
14933 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14934
14935 @table @code
14936 @item sdireset
14937 @kindex sdireset
14938 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14939 This command resets the SDI connection.
14940
14941 @item sdistatus
14942 @kindex sdistatus
14943 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14944
14945 @item debug_chaos
14946 @kindex debug_chaos
14947 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14948 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14949
14950 @item use_debug_dma
14951 @kindex use_debug_dma
14952 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14953
14954 @item use_mon_code
14955 @kindex use_mon_code
14956 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14957
14958 @item use_ib_break
14959 @kindex use_ib_break
14960 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14961
14962 @item use_dbt_break
14963 @kindex use_dbt_break
14964 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14965 @end table
14966
14967 @node M68K
14968 @subsection M68k
14969
14970 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14971 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14972
14973 @table @code
14974
14975 @kindex target dbug
14976 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14977 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14978
14979 @end table
14980
14981 @node MIPS Embedded
14982 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14983
14984 @cindex MIPS boards
14985 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14986 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14987 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14988
14989 @need 1000
14990 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14991
14992 @table @code
14993 @item target mips @var{port}
14994 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14995 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14996 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14997 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14998 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14999 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15000 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15001
15002 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15003 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15004 debugger:
15005
15006 @smallexample
15007 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15008 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15009 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15010 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15011 (@value{GDBP}) run
15012 @end smallexample
15013
15014 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15015 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15016 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15017 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15018 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15019
15020 @item target pmon @var{port}
15021 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15022 PMON ROM monitor.
15023
15024 @item target ddb @var{port}
15025 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15026 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15027
15028 @item target lsi @var{port}
15029 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15030 LSI variant of PMON.
15031
15032 @kindex target r3900
15033 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15034 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15035
15036 @kindex target array
15037 @item target array @var{dev}
15038 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15039
15040 @end table
15041
15042
15043 @noindent
15044 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15045
15046 @table @code
15047 @item set mipsfpu double
15048 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15049 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15050 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15051 @itemx show mipsfpu
15052 @kindex set mipsfpu
15053 @kindex show mipsfpu
15054 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15055 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15056 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15057 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15058 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15059 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15060 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15061 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15062 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15063 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15064 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15065 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15066 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15067
15068 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15069 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15070 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15071
15072 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15073 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15074
15075 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15076 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15077 @itemx show timeout
15078 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15079 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15080 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15081 @kindex set timeout
15082 @kindex show timeout
15083 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15084 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15085 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15086 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15087 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15088 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15089 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15090 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15091 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15092 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15093
15094 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15095 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15096 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15097 to run before stopping.
15098
15099 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15100 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15101 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15102 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15103 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15104 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15105
15106 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15107 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15108 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15109 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15110
15111 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15112 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15113 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15114 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15115 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15116 @table @asis
15117 @item pmon target
15118 @samp{PMON}
15119 @item ddb target
15120 @samp{NEC010}
15121 @item lsi target
15122 @samp{PMON>}
15123 @end table
15124
15125 @item show monitor-prompt
15126 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15127 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15128 remote monitor.
15129
15130 @item set monitor-warnings
15131 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15132 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15133 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15134 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15135 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15136
15137 @item show monitor-warnings
15138 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15139 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15140
15141 @item pmon @var{command}
15142 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15143 @cindex send PMON command
15144 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15145 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15146 @end table
15147
15148 @node OpenRISC 1000
15149 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15150 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15151
15152 @cindex or1k boards
15153 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15154 about platform and commands.
15155
15156 @table @code
15157
15158 @kindex target jtag
15159 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15160
15161 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15162 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15163 connected via parallel port to the board.
15164
15165 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15166
15167 @kindex or1ksim
15168 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15169 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15170 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15171
15172 @kindex info or1k spr
15173 @item info or1k spr
15174 Displays spr groups.
15175
15176 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15177 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15178 Displays register names in selected group.
15179
15180 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15181 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15182 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15183 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15184 Shows information about specified spr register.
15185
15186 @kindex spr
15187 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15188 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15189 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15190 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15191 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15192 @end table
15193
15194 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15195 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15196 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15197 triggers can be set using:
15198 @table @code
15199 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15200 Load effective address/data
15201 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15202 Store effective address/data
15203 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15204 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15205 @item $FETCH
15206 Fetch data
15207 @end table
15208
15209 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15210 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15211
15212 @code{htrace} commands:
15213 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15214 @table @code
15215 @kindex hwatch
15216 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15217 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15218 or Data. For example:
15219
15220 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15221
15222 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15223
15224 @kindex htrace
15225 @item htrace info
15226 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15227
15228 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15229 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15230
15231 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15232 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15233
15234 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15235 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15236
15237 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15238 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15239 triggered.
15240
15241 @item htrace enable
15242 @itemx htrace disable
15243 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15244
15245 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15246 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15247
15248 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15249 will be written there.
15250
15251 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15252 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15253
15254 @item htrace mode continuous
15255 Set continuous trace mode.
15256
15257 @item htrace mode suspend
15258 Set suspend trace mode.
15259
15260 @end table
15261
15262 @node PowerPC Embedded
15263 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15264
15265 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15266
15267 @table @code
15268 @kindex set powerpc
15269 @item set powerpc soft-float
15270 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15271 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15272 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15273 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15274
15275 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15276 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15277 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15278 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15279 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15280 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15281 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15282 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15283
15284 @kindex target dink32
15285 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15286 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15287
15288 @kindex target ppcbug
15289 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15290 @kindex target ppcbug1
15291 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15292 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15293
15294 @kindex target sds
15295 @item target sds @var{dev}
15296 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15297 @end table
15298
15299 @cindex SDS protocol
15300 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15301 by @value{GDBN}:
15302
15303 @table @code
15304 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15305 @kindex set sdstimeout
15306 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15307 default is 2 seconds.
15308
15309 @item show sdstimeout
15310 @kindex show sdstimeout
15311 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15312
15313 @item sds @var{command}
15314 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15315 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15316 @end table
15317
15318
15319 @node PA
15320 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15321
15322 @table @code
15323
15324 @kindex target op50n
15325 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15326 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15327
15328 @kindex target w89k
15329 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15330 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15331
15332 @end table
15333
15334 @node Sparclet
15335 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15336
15337 @cindex Sparclet
15338
15339 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15340 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15341 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15342 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15343 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15344
15345 @table @code
15346 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15347 @kindex remotetimeout
15348 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15349 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15350 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15351 @end table
15352
15353 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15354 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15355 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15356 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15357 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15358
15359 @smallexample
15360 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15361 @end smallexample
15362
15363 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15364
15365 @smallexample
15366 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15367 @end smallexample
15368
15369 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15370 Once you have set
15371 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15372 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15373 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15374
15375 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15376
15377 @smallexample
15378 (gdbslet)
15379 @end smallexample
15380
15381 @menu
15382 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15383 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15384 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15385 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15386 @end menu
15387
15388 @node Sparclet File
15389 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15390
15391 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15392
15393 @smallexample
15394 (gdbslet) file prog
15395 @end smallexample
15396
15397 @need 1000
15398 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15399 @value{GDBN} locates
15400 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15401 path.
15402 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15403 files will be searched as well.
15404 @value{GDBN} locates
15405 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15406 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15407 If it fails
15408 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15409
15410 @smallexample
15411 prog: No such file or directory.
15412 @end smallexample
15413
15414 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15415 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15416 @code{target} command again.
15417
15418 @node Sparclet Connection
15419 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15420
15421 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15422 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15423
15424 @smallexample
15425 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15426 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15427 main () at ../prog.c:3
15428 @end smallexample
15429
15430 @need 750
15431 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15432
15433 @smallexample
15434 Connected to ttya.
15435 @end smallexample
15436
15437 @node Sparclet Download
15438 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15439
15440 @cindex download to Sparclet
15441 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15442 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15443 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15444 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15445 command.
15446 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15447 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15448 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15449 of each of the file's sections.
15450 For instance, if the program
15451 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15452 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15453
15454 @smallexample
15455 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15456 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15457 @end smallexample
15458
15459 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15460 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15461 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15462
15463 @node Sparclet Execution
15464 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15465
15466 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15467 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15468 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15469 manual for the list of commands.
15470
15471 @smallexample
15472 (gdbslet) b main
15473 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15474 (gdbslet) run
15475 Starting program: prog
15476 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15477 3 char *symarg = 0;
15478 (gdbslet) step
15479 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15480 (gdbslet)
15481 @end smallexample
15482
15483 @node Sparclite
15484 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15485
15486 @table @code
15487
15488 @kindex target sparclite
15489 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15490 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15491 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15492 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15493 remote protocol.
15494
15495 @end table
15496
15497 @node Z8000
15498 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15499
15500 @cindex Z8000
15501 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15502 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15503
15504 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15505 a Z8000 simulator.
15506
15507 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15508 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15509 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15510 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15511
15512 @table @code
15513 @item target sim @var{args}
15514 @kindex sim
15515 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15516 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15517 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15518 @end table
15519
15520 @noindent
15521 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15522 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15523 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15524 to run your program, and so on.
15525
15526 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15527 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15528 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15529
15530 @table @code
15531
15532 @item cycles
15533 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15534
15535 @item insts
15536 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15537
15538 @item time
15539 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15540
15541 @end table
15542
15543 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15544 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15545 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15546 simulated clock ticks.
15547
15548 @node AVR
15549 @subsection Atmel AVR
15550 @cindex AVR
15551
15552 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15553 following AVR-specific commands:
15554
15555 @table @code
15556 @item info io_registers
15557 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15558 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15559 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15560 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15561 @end table
15562
15563 @node CRIS
15564 @subsection CRIS
15565 @cindex CRIS
15566
15567 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15568 following CRIS-specific commands:
15569
15570 @table @code
15571 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15572 @cindex CRIS version
15573 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15574 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15575 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15576
15577 @item show cris-version
15578 Show the current CRIS version.
15579
15580 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15581 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15582 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15583 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15584 @code{R59}.
15585
15586 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15587 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15588
15589 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15590 @cindex CRIS mode
15591 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15592 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15593 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15594
15595 @item show cris-mode
15596 Show the current CRIS mode.
15597 @end table
15598
15599 @node Super-H
15600 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15601 @cindex Super-H
15602
15603 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15604 commands:
15605
15606 @table @code
15607 @item regs
15608 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15609 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15610 @end table
15611
15612
15613 @node Architectures
15614 @section Architectures
15615
15616 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15617 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15618
15619 @menu
15620 * i386::
15621 * A29K::
15622 * Alpha::
15623 * MIPS::
15624 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15625 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15626 * PowerPC::
15627 @end menu
15628
15629 @node i386
15630 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15631
15632 @table @code
15633 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15634 @kindex set struct-convention
15635 @cindex struct return convention
15636 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15637 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15638 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15639 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15640 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15641 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15642 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15643 be returned in a register.
15644
15645 @item show struct-convention
15646 @kindex show struct-convention
15647 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15648 from functions.
15649 @end table
15650
15651 @node A29K
15652 @subsection A29K
15653
15654 @table @code
15655
15656 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15657 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15658 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15659 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15660 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15661 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15662 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15663 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15664 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15665 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15666 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15667 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15668 hexadecimal.
15669
15670 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15671 @item show rstack_high_address
15672 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15673 processors.
15674
15675 @end table
15676
15677 @node Alpha
15678 @subsection Alpha
15679
15680 See the following section.
15681
15682 @node MIPS
15683 @subsection MIPS
15684
15685 @cindex stack on Alpha
15686 @cindex stack on MIPS
15687 @cindex Alpha stack
15688 @cindex MIPS stack
15689 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15690 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15691 find the beginning of a function.
15692
15693 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15694 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15695 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15696 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15697 commands:
15698
15699 @table @code
15700 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15701 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15702 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15703 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15704 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15705 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15706 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15707 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15708
15709 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15710 Display the current limit.
15711 @end table
15712
15713 @noindent
15714 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15715 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15716
15717 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15718 programs:
15719
15720 @table @code
15721 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15722 @kindex set mips abi
15723 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15724 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15725 values of @var{arg} are:
15726
15727 @table @samp
15728 @item auto
15729 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15730 default).
15731 @item o32
15732 @item o64
15733 @item n32
15734 @item n64
15735 @item eabi32
15736 @item eabi64
15737 @item auto
15738 @end table
15739
15740 @item show mips abi
15741 @kindex show mips abi
15742 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15743
15744 @item set mipsfpu
15745 @itemx show mipsfpu
15746 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15747
15748 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15749 @kindex set mips mask-address
15750 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15751 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15752 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15753 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15754 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15755
15756 @item show mips mask-address
15757 @kindex show mips mask-address
15758 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15759 not.
15760
15761 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15762 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15763 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15764 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15765 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15766 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15767
15768 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15769 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15770 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15771
15772 @item set debug mips
15773 @kindex set debug mips
15774 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15775 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15776
15777 @item show debug mips
15778 @kindex show debug mips
15779 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15780 @end table
15781
15782
15783 @node HPPA
15784 @subsection HPPA
15785 @cindex HPPA support
15786
15787 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15788 following special commands:
15789
15790 @table @code
15791 @item set debug hppa
15792 @kindex set debug hppa
15793 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15794 messages are to be displayed.
15795
15796 @item show debug hppa
15797 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15798
15799 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15800 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15801 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15802 given @var{address}.
15803
15804 @end table
15805
15806
15807 @node SPU
15808 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15809 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15810 @cindex SPU
15811
15812 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15813 it provides the following special commands:
15814
15815 @table @code
15816 @item info spu event
15817 @kindex info spu
15818 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15819 and pending event status.
15820
15821 @item info spu signal
15822 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15823 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15824 notification channels.
15825
15826 @item info spu mailbox
15827 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15828 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15829 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15830
15831 @item info spu dma
15832 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15833 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15834 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15835
15836 @item info spu proxydma
15837 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15838 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15839 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15840
15841 @end table
15842
15843 @node PowerPC
15844 @subsection PowerPC
15845 @cindex PowerPC architecture
15846
15847 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
15848 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
15849 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
15850 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
15851 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
15852
15853 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
15854 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
15855 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
15856
15857
15858 @node Controlling GDB
15859 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15860
15861 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15862 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15863 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15864 described here.
15865
15866 @menu
15867 * Prompt:: Prompt
15868 * Editing:: Command editing
15869 * Command History:: Command history
15870 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15871 * Numbers:: Numbers
15872 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15873 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15874 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15875 @end menu
15876
15877 @node Prompt
15878 @section Prompt
15879
15880 @cindex prompt
15881
15882 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15883 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15884 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15885 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15886 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15887 which one you are talking to.
15888
15889 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15890 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15891 or a prompt that does not.
15892
15893 @table @code
15894 @kindex set prompt
15895 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15896 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15897
15898 @kindex show prompt
15899 @item show prompt
15900 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15901 @end table
15902
15903 @node Editing
15904 @section Command Editing
15905 @cindex readline
15906 @cindex command line editing
15907
15908 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15909 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15910 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15911 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15912 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15913 debugging sessions.
15914
15915 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15916 command @code{set}.
15917
15918 @table @code
15919 @kindex set editing
15920 @cindex editing
15921 @item set editing
15922 @itemx set editing on
15923 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15924
15925 @item set editing off
15926 Disable command line editing.
15927
15928 @kindex show editing
15929 @item show editing
15930 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15931 @end table
15932
15933 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15934 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15935 encouraged to read that chapter.
15936
15937 @node Command History
15938 @section Command History
15939 @cindex command history
15940
15941 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15942 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15943 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15944 history facility.
15945
15946 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15947 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15948 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15949
15950 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15951 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15952 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15953 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15954 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15955 pressed on a line by itself.
15956
15957 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15958 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15959 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15960 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15961
15962 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15963 history.
15964
15965 @table @code
15966 @cindex history substitution
15967 @cindex history file
15968 @kindex set history filename
15969 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15970 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15971 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15972 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15973 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15974 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15975 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15976 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15977 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15978 is not set.
15979
15980 @cindex save command history
15981 @kindex set history save
15982 @item set history save
15983 @itemx set history save on
15984 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15985 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15986
15987 @item set history save off
15988 Stop recording command history in a file.
15989
15990 @cindex history size
15991 @kindex set history size
15992 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15993 @item set history size @var{size}
15994 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15995 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15996 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15997 @end table
15998
15999 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16000 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16001
16002 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16003 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16004 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16005 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16006 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16007 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16008 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16009 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16010
16011 The commands to control history expansion are:
16012
16013 @table @code
16014 @item set history expansion on
16015 @itemx set history expansion
16016 @kindex set history expansion
16017 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16018
16019 @item set history expansion off
16020 Disable history expansion.
16021
16022 @c @group
16023 @kindex show history
16024 @item show history
16025 @itemx show history filename
16026 @itemx show history save
16027 @itemx show history size
16028 @itemx show history expansion
16029 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16030 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16031 @c @end group
16032 @end table
16033
16034 @table @code
16035 @kindex show commands
16036 @cindex show last commands
16037 @cindex display command history
16038 @item show commands
16039 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16040
16041 @item show commands @var{n}
16042 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16043
16044 @item show commands +
16045 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16046 @end table
16047
16048 @node Screen Size
16049 @section Screen Size
16050 @cindex size of screen
16051 @cindex pauses in output
16052
16053 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16054 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16055 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16056 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16057 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16058 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16059 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16060 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16061
16062 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16063 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16064 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16065 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16066 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16067 width} commands:
16068
16069 @table @code
16070 @kindex set height
16071 @kindex set width
16072 @kindex show width
16073 @kindex show height
16074 @item set height @var{lpp}
16075 @itemx show height
16076 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16077 @itemx show width
16078 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16079 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16080 commands display the current settings.
16081
16082 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16083 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16084 file or to an editor buffer.
16085
16086 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16087 from wrapping its output.
16088
16089 @item set pagination on
16090 @itemx set pagination off
16091 @kindex set pagination
16092 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16093 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16094
16095 @item show pagination
16096 @kindex show pagination
16097 Show the current pagination mode.
16098 @end table
16099
16100 @node Numbers
16101 @section Numbers
16102 @cindex number representation
16103 @cindex entering numbers
16104
16105 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16106 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16107 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16108 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16109 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16110 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16111 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16112 both input and output with the commands described below.
16113
16114 @table @code
16115 @kindex set input-radix
16116 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16117 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16118 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16119 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16120 example, any of
16121
16122 @smallexample
16123 set input-radix 012
16124 set input-radix 10.
16125 set input-radix 0xa
16126 @end smallexample
16127
16128 @noindent
16129 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16130 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16131 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16132 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16133 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16134 change the radix.
16135
16136 @kindex set output-radix
16137 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16138 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16139 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16140 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16141
16142 @kindex show input-radix
16143 @item show input-radix
16144 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16145
16146 @kindex show output-radix
16147 @item show output-radix
16148 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16149
16150 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16151 @itemx show radix
16152 @kindex set radix
16153 @kindex show radix
16154 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16155 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16156 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16157 default value of 10.
16158
16159 @end table
16160
16161 @node ABI
16162 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16163
16164 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16165 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16166 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16167 current ABI.
16168
16169 @cindex OS ABI
16170 @kindex set osabi
16171 @kindex show osabi
16172
16173 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16174 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16175 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16176 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16177 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16178 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16179 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16180 platform provides.
16181
16182 @table @code
16183 @item show osabi
16184 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16185
16186 @item set osabi
16187 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16188
16189 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16190 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16191 @end table
16192
16193 @cindex float promotion
16194
16195 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16196 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16197 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16198 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16199 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16200 @code{double} and then passed.
16201
16202 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16203 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16204 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16205
16206 @table @code
16207 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16208 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16209 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16210 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16211 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16212
16213 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16214 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16215 functions.
16216
16217 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16218 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16219 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16220 @end table
16221
16222 @kindex set cp-abi
16223 @kindex show cp-abi
16224 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16225 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16226 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16227 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16228 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16229 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16230 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16231 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16232 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16233 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16234 ``auto''.
16235
16236 @table @code
16237 @item show cp-abi
16238 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16239
16240 @item set cp-abi
16241 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16242
16243 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16244 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16245 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16246 @end table
16247
16248 @node Messages/Warnings
16249 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16250
16251 @cindex verbose operation
16252 @cindex optional warnings
16253 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16254 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16255 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16256 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16257
16258 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16259 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16260 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16261
16262 @table @code
16263 @kindex set verbose
16264 @item set verbose on
16265 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16266
16267 @item set verbose off
16268 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16269
16270 @kindex show verbose
16271 @item show verbose
16272 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16273 @end table
16274
16275 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16276 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16277 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16278 Symbol Files}).
16279
16280 @table @code
16281
16282 @kindex set complaints
16283 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16284 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16285 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16286 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16287 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16288
16289 @kindex show complaints
16290 @item show complaints
16291 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16292
16293 @end table
16294
16295 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16296 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16297 you try to run a program which is already running:
16298
16299 @smallexample
16300 (@value{GDBP}) run
16301 The program being debugged has been started already.
16302 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16303 @end smallexample
16304
16305 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16306 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16307
16308 @table @code
16309
16310 @kindex set confirm
16311 @cindex flinching
16312 @cindex confirmation
16313 @cindex stupid questions
16314 @item set confirm off
16315 Disables confirmation requests.
16316
16317 @item set confirm on
16318 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16319
16320 @kindex show confirm
16321 @item show confirm
16322 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16323
16324 @end table
16325
16326 @cindex command tracing
16327 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16328 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16329 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16330 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16331
16332 @table @code
16333 @kindex set trace-commands
16334 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16335 @item set trace-commands on
16336 Enable command tracing.
16337 @item set trace-commands off
16338 Disable command tracing.
16339 @item show trace-commands
16340 Display the current state of command tracing.
16341 @end table
16342
16343 @node Debugging Output
16344 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16345 @cindex optional debugging messages
16346
16347 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16348 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16349 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16350 section documents those commands.
16351
16352 @table @code
16353 @kindex set exec-done-display
16354 @item set exec-done-display
16355 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16356 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16357 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16358 @kindex show exec-done-display
16359 @item show exec-done-display
16360 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16361 notification.
16362 @kindex set debug
16363 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16364 @cindex architecture debugging info
16365 @item set debug arch
16366 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16367 @kindex show debug
16368 @item show debug arch
16369 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16370 @item set debug aix-thread
16371 @cindex AIX threads
16372 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16373 module.
16374 @item show debug aix-thread
16375 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16376 @item set debug event
16377 @cindex event debugging info
16378 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16379 default is off.
16380 @item show debug event
16381 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16382 info.
16383 @item set debug expression
16384 @cindex expression debugging info
16385 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16386 expression parsing. The default is off.
16387 @item show debug expression
16388 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16389 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16390 @item set debug frame
16391 @cindex frame debugging info
16392 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16393 default is off.
16394 @item show debug frame
16395 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16396 info.
16397 @item set debug infrun
16398 @cindex inferior debugging info
16399 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16400 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16401 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16402 @item show debug infrun
16403 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16404 @item set debug lin-lwp
16405 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16406 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16407 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16408 @item show debug lin-lwp
16409 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16410 @item set debug observer
16411 @cindex observer debugging info
16412 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16413 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16414 @item show debug observer
16415 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16416 @item set debug overload
16417 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16418 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16419 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16420 is off.
16421 @item show debug overload
16422 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16423 debugging info.
16424 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16425 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16426 @cindex debug remote protocol
16427 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16428 @cindex display remote packets
16429 @item set debug remote
16430 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16431 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16432 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16433 @item show debug remote
16434 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16435 @item set debug serial
16436 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16437 default is off.
16438 @item show debug serial
16439 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16440 info.
16441 @item set debug solib-frv
16442 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16443 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16444 @item show debug solib-frv
16445 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16446 messages.
16447 @item set debug target
16448 @cindex target debugging info
16449 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16450 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16451 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16452 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16453 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16454 @item show debug target
16455 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16456 info.
16457 @item set debug timestamp
16458 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16459 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16460 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16461 message.
16462 @item show debug timestamp
16463 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16464 debugging info.
16465 @item set debugvarobj
16466 @cindex variable object debugging info
16467 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16468 info. The default is off.
16469 @item show debugvarobj
16470 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16471 debugging info.
16472 @item set debug xml
16473 @cindex XML parser debugging
16474 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16475 @item show debug xml
16476 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16477 @end table
16478
16479 @node Sequences
16480 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16481
16482 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16483 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16484 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16485 files.
16486
16487 @menu
16488 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16489 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16490 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16491 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16492 @end menu
16493
16494 @node Define
16495 @section User-defined Commands
16496
16497 @cindex user-defined command
16498 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16499 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16500 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16501 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16502 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16503 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16504
16505 @smallexample
16506 define adder
16507 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16508 end
16509 @end smallexample
16510
16511 @noindent
16512 To execute the command use:
16513
16514 @smallexample
16515 adder 1 2 3
16516 @end smallexample
16517
16518 @noindent
16519 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16520 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16521 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16522 functions calls.
16523
16524 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16525 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16526 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16527 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16528
16529 @smallexample
16530 define adder
16531 if $argc == 2
16532 print $arg0 + $arg1
16533 end
16534 if $argc == 3
16535 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16536 end
16537 end
16538 @end smallexample
16539
16540 @table @code
16541
16542 @kindex define
16543 @item define @var{commandname}
16544 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16545 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16546
16547 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16548 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16549 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16550
16551 @kindex document
16552 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16553 @item document @var{commandname}
16554 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16555 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16556 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16557 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16558 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16559 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16560
16561 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16562 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16563 does not change the documentation.
16564
16565 @kindex dont-repeat
16566 @cindex don't repeat command
16567 @item dont-repeat
16568 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16569 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16570 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16571
16572 @kindex help user-defined
16573 @item help user-defined
16574 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16575 (if any) for each.
16576
16577 @kindex show user
16578 @item show user
16579 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16580 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16581 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16582 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16583
16584 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16585 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16586 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16587 @item show max-user-call-depth
16588 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16589 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16590 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16591 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16592 @end table
16593
16594 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16595 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16596
16597 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16598 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16599 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16600
16601 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16602 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16603 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16604 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16605
16606 @node Hooks
16607 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16608 @cindex command hooks
16609 @cindex hooks, for commands
16610 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16611
16612 @kindex hook
16613 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16614 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16615 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16616 before that command.
16617
16618 @cindex hooks, post-command
16619 @kindex hookpost
16620 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16621 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16622 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16623 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16624 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16625
16626 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16627 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16628
16629 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16630 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16631
16632 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16633 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16634 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16635 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16636 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16637
16638 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16639 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16640 you could define:
16641
16642 @smallexample
16643 define hook-stop
16644 handle SIGALRM nopass
16645 end
16646
16647 define hook-run
16648 handle SIGALRM pass
16649 end
16650
16651 define hook-continue
16652 handle SIGALRM pass
16653 end
16654 @end smallexample
16655
16656 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16657 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16658 you could define:
16659
16660 @smallexample
16661 define hook-echo
16662 echo <<<---
16663 end
16664
16665 define hookpost-echo
16666 echo --->>>\n
16667 end
16668
16669 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16670 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16671 (@value{GDBP})
16672
16673 @end smallexample
16674
16675 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16676 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16677 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16678 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16679 @c or not?
16680 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16681 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16682 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16683
16684 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16685 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16686
16687 @node Command Files
16688 @section Command Files
16689
16690 @cindex command files
16691 @cindex scripting commands
16692 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16693 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16694 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16695 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16696 terminal.
16697
16698 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16699 command:
16700
16701 @table @code
16702 @kindex source
16703 @cindex execute commands from a file
16704 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16705 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16706 @end table
16707
16708 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16709 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16710 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16711 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16712 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16713
16714 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16715 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16716
16717 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16718 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16719 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16720
16721 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16722 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16723 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16724 when called from command files.
16725
16726 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16727 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16728 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16729 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16730 the next command.
16731
16732 @smallexample
16733 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16734 @end smallexample
16735
16736 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16737 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16738 would be directed to @file{log}.
16739
16740 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16741 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16742 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16743 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16744 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16745 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16746 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16747 conditionally, etc.
16748
16749 @table @code
16750 @kindex if
16751 @kindex else
16752 @item if
16753 @itemx else
16754 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16755 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16756 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16757 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16758 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16759 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16760 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16761
16762 @kindex while
16763 @item while
16764 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16765 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16766 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16767 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16768 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16769 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16770
16771 @kindex loop_break
16772 @item loop_break
16773 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16774 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16775 line.
16776
16777 @kindex loop_continue
16778 @item loop_continue
16779 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16780 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16781 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16782 the controlling expression.
16783
16784 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16785 @item end
16786 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16787 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16788 @end table
16789
16790
16791 @node Output
16792 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16793
16794 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16795 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16796 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16797 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16798 want.
16799
16800 @table @code
16801 @kindex echo
16802 @item echo @var{text}
16803 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16804 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16805 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16806 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16807 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16808 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16809 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16810 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16811 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16812 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16813 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16814
16815 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16816 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16817
16818 @smallexample
16819 echo This is some text\n\
16820 which is continued\n\
16821 onto several lines.\n
16822 @end smallexample
16823
16824 produces the same output as
16825
16826 @smallexample
16827 echo This is some text\n
16828 echo which is continued\n
16829 echo onto several lines.\n
16830 @end smallexample
16831
16832 @kindex output
16833 @item output @var{expression}
16834 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16835 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16836 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16837 on expressions.
16838
16839 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16840 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16841 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16842 Formats}, for more information.
16843
16844 @kindex printf
16845 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16846 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16847 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16848 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16849 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16850 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16851 executing the code below:
16852
16853 @smallexample
16854 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16855 @end smallexample
16856
16857 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16858 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16859 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16860 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16861 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16862 printed.
16863
16864 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16865
16866 @smallexample
16867 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16868 @end smallexample
16869
16870 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16871 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16872 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16873
16874 @itemize @bullet
16875 @item
16876 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16877
16878 @item
16879 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16880 width.
16881
16882 @item
16883 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16884 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16885
16886 @item
16887 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16888 supported.
16889
16890 @item
16891 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16892
16893 @item
16894 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16895 @end itemize
16896
16897 @noindent
16898 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16899 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16900 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16901 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16902
16903 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16904 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16905 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16906 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16907 supported.
16908
16909 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16910 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16911 together with a floating point specifier.
16912 letters:
16913
16914 @itemize @bullet
16915 @item
16916 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16917
16918 @item
16919 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16920
16921 @item
16922 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16923 @end itemize
16924
16925 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16926 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16927 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16928
16929 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16930 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16931
16932 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16933 @smallexample
16934 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16935 @end smallexample
16936
16937 @end table
16938
16939 @node Interpreters
16940 @chapter Command Interpreters
16941 @cindex command interpreters
16942
16943 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16944 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16945 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16946
16947 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16948 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16949 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16950 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16951
16952 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16953 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16954 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16955 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16956
16957 @table @code
16958 @item console
16959 @cindex console interpreter
16960 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16961 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16962 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16963
16964 @item mi
16965 @cindex mi interpreter
16966 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16967 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16968 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16969 Interface}.
16970
16971 @item mi2
16972 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16973 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16974
16975 @item mi1
16976 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16977 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16978
16979 @end table
16980
16981 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16982 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16983 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16984 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16985 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16986 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16987 the IDE inoperable!
16988
16989 @kindex interpreter-exec
16990 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16991 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16992 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16993 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16994
16995 @smallexample
16996 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16997 @end smallexample
16998
16999 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17000 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17001
17002 @node TUI
17003 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17004 @cindex TUI
17005 @cindex Text User Interface
17006
17007 @menu
17008 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17009 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17010 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17011 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17012 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17013 @end menu
17014
17015 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17016 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17017 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17018 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17019 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17020 is available.
17021
17022 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17023 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17024 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17025 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17026 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17027 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17028
17029 @node TUI Overview
17030 @section TUI Overview
17031
17032 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17033
17034 @table @emph
17035 @item command
17036 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17037 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17038 managed using readline.
17039
17040 @item source
17041 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17042 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17043
17044 @item assembly
17045 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17046
17047 @item register
17048 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17049 when their values change.
17050 @end table
17051
17052 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17053 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17054 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17055 indicates the breakpoint type:
17056
17057 @table @code
17058 @item B
17059 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17060
17061 @item b
17062 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17063
17064 @item H
17065 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17066
17067 @item h
17068 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17069 @end table
17070
17071 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17072
17073 @table @code
17074 @item +
17075 Breakpoint is enabled.
17076
17077 @item -
17078 Breakpoint is disabled.
17079 @end table
17080
17081 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17082 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17083 changes.
17084
17085 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17086 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17087 layouts:
17088
17089 @itemize @bullet
17090 @item
17091 source only,
17092
17093 @item
17094 assembly only,
17095
17096 @item
17097 source and assembly,
17098
17099 @item
17100 source and registers, or
17101
17102 @item
17103 assembly and registers.
17104 @end itemize
17105
17106 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17107
17108 @table @emph
17109 @item target
17110 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17111 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17112
17113 @item process
17114 Gives the current process or thread number.
17115 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17116
17117 @item function
17118 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17119 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17120 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17121 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17122
17123 @item line
17124 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17125 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17126
17127 @item pc
17128 Indicates the current program counter address.
17129 @end table
17130
17131 @node TUI Keys
17132 @section TUI Key Bindings
17133 @cindex TUI key bindings
17134
17135 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17136 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17137 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17138
17139 @table @kbd
17140 @kindex C-x C-a
17141 @item C-x C-a
17142 @kindex C-x a
17143 @itemx C-x a
17144 @kindex C-x A
17145 @itemx C-x A
17146 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17147 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17148 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17149 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17150 The screen is then refreshed.
17151
17152 @kindex C-x 1
17153 @item C-x 1
17154 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17155 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17156 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17157
17158 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17159
17160 @kindex C-x 2
17161 @item C-x 2
17162 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17163 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17164 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17165 previous layout and the new one.
17166
17167 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17168
17169 @kindex C-x o
17170 @item C-x o
17171 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17172 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17173 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17174
17175 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17176
17177 @kindex C-x s
17178 @item C-x s
17179 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17180 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17181 @end table
17182
17183 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17184
17185 @table @asis
17186 @kindex PgUp
17187 @item @key{PgUp}
17188 Scroll the active window one page up.
17189
17190 @kindex PgDn
17191 @item @key{PgDn}
17192 Scroll the active window one page down.
17193
17194 @kindex Up
17195 @item @key{Up}
17196 Scroll the active window one line up.
17197
17198 @kindex Down
17199 @item @key{Down}
17200 Scroll the active window one line down.
17201
17202 @kindex Left
17203 @item @key{Left}
17204 Scroll the active window one column left.
17205
17206 @kindex Right
17207 @item @key{Right}
17208 Scroll the active window one column right.
17209
17210 @kindex C-L
17211 @item @kbd{C-L}
17212 Refresh the screen.
17213 @end table
17214
17215 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17216 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17217 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17218 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17219 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17220
17221 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17222 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17223 @cindex TUI single key mode
17224
17225 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17226 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17227 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17228
17229 @table @kbd
17230 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17231 @item c
17232 continue
17233
17234 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17235 @item d
17236 down
17237
17238 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17239 @item f
17240 finish
17241
17242 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17243 @item n
17244 next
17245
17246 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17247 @item q
17248 exit the SingleKey mode.
17249
17250 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17251 @item r
17252 run
17253
17254 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17255 @item s
17256 step
17257
17258 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17259 @item u
17260 up
17261
17262 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17263 @item v
17264 info locals
17265
17266 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17267 @item w
17268 where
17269 @end table
17270
17271 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17272 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17273 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17274 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17275 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17276 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17277
17278
17279 @node TUI Commands
17280 @section TUI-specific Commands
17281 @cindex TUI commands
17282
17283 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17284 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17285 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17286 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17287
17288 @table @code
17289 @item info win
17290 @kindex info win
17291 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17292
17293 @item layout next
17294 @kindex layout
17295 Display the next layout.
17296
17297 @item layout prev
17298 Display the previous layout.
17299
17300 @item layout src
17301 Display the source window only.
17302
17303 @item layout asm
17304 Display the assembly window only.
17305
17306 @item layout split
17307 Display the source and assembly window.
17308
17309 @item layout regs
17310 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17311
17312 @item focus next
17313 @kindex focus
17314 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17315
17316 @item focus prev
17317 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17318
17319 @item focus src
17320 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17321
17322 @item focus asm
17323 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17324
17325 @item focus regs
17326 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17327
17328 @item focus cmd
17329 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17330
17331 @item refresh
17332 @kindex refresh
17333 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17334
17335 @item tui reg float
17336 @kindex tui reg
17337 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17338
17339 @item tui reg general
17340 Show the general registers in the register window.
17341
17342 @item tui reg next
17343 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17344 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17345 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17346 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17347
17348 @item tui reg system
17349 Show the system registers in the register window.
17350
17351 @item update
17352 @kindex update
17353 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17354
17355 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17356 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17357 @kindex winheight
17358 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17359 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17360 decrease it.
17361
17362 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17363 @kindex tabset
17364 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17365 @end table
17366
17367 @node TUI Configuration
17368 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17369 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17370
17371 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17372
17373 @table @code
17374 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17375 @kindex set tui border-kind
17376 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17377 The possible values are the following:
17378 @table @code
17379 @item space
17380 Use a space character to draw the border.
17381
17382 @item ascii
17383 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17384
17385 @item acs
17386 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17387 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17388 @end table
17389
17390 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17391 @kindex set tui border-mode
17392 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17393 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17394 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17395 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17396 @table @code
17397 @item normal
17398 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17399
17400 @item standout
17401 Use standout mode.
17402
17403 @item reverse
17404 Use reverse video mode.
17405
17406 @item half
17407 Use half bright mode.
17408
17409 @item half-standout
17410 Use half bright and standout mode.
17411
17412 @item bold
17413 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17414
17415 @item bold-standout
17416 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17417 @end table
17418 @end table
17419
17420 @node Emacs
17421 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17422
17423 @cindex Emacs
17424 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17425 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17426 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17427 @value{GDBN}.
17428
17429 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17430 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17431 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17432 created Emacs buffer.
17433 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17434
17435 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17436 things:
17437
17438 @itemize @bullet
17439 @item
17440 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17441 the GUD buffer.
17442
17443 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17444 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17445
17446 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17447 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17448 in this way.
17449
17450 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17451 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17452 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17453 stop.
17454
17455 @item
17456 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17457
17458 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17459 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17460 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17461 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17462 and the source.
17463
17464 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17465 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17466 @end itemize
17467
17468 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17469 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17470 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17471 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17472
17473 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17474 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17475 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17476 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17477 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17478 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17479 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17480 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17481 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17482
17483 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17484 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17485 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17486 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17487
17488 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17489 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17490 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17491 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17492 one you want.
17493
17494 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17495 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17496
17497 @table @kbd
17498 @item C-h m
17499 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17500
17501 @item C-c C-s
17502 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17503 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17504
17505 @item C-c C-n
17506 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17507 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17508 to show the current file and location.
17509
17510 @item C-c C-i
17511 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17512 display window accordingly.
17513
17514 @item C-c C-f
17515 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17516 @code{finish} command.
17517
17518 @item C-c C-r
17519 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17520 command.
17521
17522 @item C-c <
17523 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17524 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17525 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17526
17527 @item C-c >
17528 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17529 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17530 @end table
17531
17532 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17533 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17534
17535 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17536 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17537 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17538 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17539 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17540 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17541 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17542
17543 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17544 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17545 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17546 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17547 frame.
17548
17549 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17550 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17551 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17552 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17553 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17554 to correspond properly with the code.
17555
17556 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17557 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17558 Emacs Manual}).
17559
17560 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17561 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17562 @ignore
17563 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17564 @kindex Epoch
17565 @kindex inspect
17566
17567 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17568 called the @code{epoch}
17569 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17570 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17571 each value is printed in its own window.
17572 @end ignore
17573
17574
17575 @node GDB/MI
17576 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17577
17578 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17579
17580 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17581 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17582 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17583 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17584 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17585 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17586
17587 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17588 in the form of a reference manual.
17589
17590 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17591 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17592 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17593
17594 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17595
17596 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17597 This chapter uses the following notation:
17598
17599 @itemize @bullet
17600 @item
17601 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17602
17603 @item
17604 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17605 it may or may not be given.
17606
17607 @item
17608 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17609 may repeat zero or more times.
17610
17611 @item
17612 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17613 may repeat one or more times.
17614
17615 @item
17616 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17617 @end itemize
17618
17619 @ignore
17620 @heading Dependencies
17621 @end ignore
17622
17623 @menu
17624 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17625 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17626 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17627 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17628 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17629 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17630 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17631 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17632 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17633 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17634 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17635 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17636 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17637 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17638 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17639 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17640 @ignore
17641 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17642 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17643 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17644 @end ignore
17645 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17646 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17647 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17648 @end menu
17649
17650 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17651 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17652 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17653
17654 @menu
17655 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17656 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17657 @end menu
17658
17659 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17660 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17661
17662 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17663 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17664 @table @code
17665 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17666 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17667
17668 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17669 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17670 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17671
17672 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17673 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17674 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17675
17676 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17677 "any sequence of digits"
17678
17679 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17680 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17681
17682 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17683 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17684
17685 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17686 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17687
17688 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17689 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17690 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17691
17692 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17693 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17694
17695 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17696 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17697 @end table
17698
17699 @noindent
17700 Notes:
17701
17702 @itemize @bullet
17703 @item
17704 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17705 output is described below.
17706
17707 @item
17708 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17709 finishes.
17710
17711 @item
17712 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17713 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17714 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17715 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17716 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17717 @end itemize
17718
17719 Pragmatics:
17720
17721 @itemize @bullet
17722 @item
17723 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17724
17725 @item
17726 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17727 @end itemize
17728
17729 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17730 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17731
17732 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17733 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17734 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17735 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17736 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17737 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17738
17739 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17740 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17741 @var{token}.
17742
17743 @table @code
17744 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17745 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17746
17747 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17748 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17749
17750 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17751 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17752
17753 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17754 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17755
17756 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17757 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17758
17759 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17760 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17761
17762 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17763 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17764
17765 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17766 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17767
17768 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17769 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17770
17771 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17772 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17773 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17774
17775 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17776 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17777
17778 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17779 @code{ @var{string} }
17780
17781 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17782 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17783
17784 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17785 @code{@var{c-string}}
17786
17787 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17788 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17789
17790 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17791 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17792 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17793
17794 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17795 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17796
17797 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17798 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17799
17800 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17801 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17802
17803 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17804 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17805
17806 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17807 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17808
17809 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17810 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17811 @end table
17812
17813 @noindent
17814 Notes:
17815
17816 @itemize @bullet
17817 @item
17818 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17819
17820 @item
17821 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17822 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17823 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17824 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17825
17826 @item
17827 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17828 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17829 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17830 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17831
17832 @item
17833 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17834 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17835 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17836 @samp{*}.
17837
17838 @item
17839 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17840 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17841 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17842 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17843
17844 @item
17845 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17846 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17847 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17848 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17849
17850 @item
17851 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17852 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17853 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17854
17855 @item
17856 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17857 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17858 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17859 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17860
17861 @item
17862 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17863 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17864 @var{values}.
17865
17866
17867 @end itemize
17868
17869 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17870 details about the various output records.
17871
17872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17873 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17875
17876 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17877 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17878
17879 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17880 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17881 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17882 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17883 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17884 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17885
17886 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17887 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17888 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17889
17890 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17891 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17892 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17893 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17894
17895 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17896 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17897
17898 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17899 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17900 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17901 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17902 might change.
17903
17904 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17905 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17906 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17907 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17908
17909 @itemize @bullet
17910 @item
17911 New MI commands may be added.
17912
17913 @item
17914 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17915
17916 @item
17917 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17918 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17919
17920 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17921 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17922
17923 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17924 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17925 @end itemize
17926
17927 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17928 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17929 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17930 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17931 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17932
17933 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17934 @c version?
17935
17936 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17937 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17938 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17939 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17940 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17941 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17942 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17943 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17944 @cindex mailing lists
17945
17946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17947 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17949
17950 @menu
17951 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17952 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17953 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17954 @end menu
17955
17956 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17957 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17958
17959 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17960 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17961 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17962 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17963
17964 @table @code
17965 @findex ^done
17966 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17967 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17968 values.
17969
17970 @item "^running"
17971 @findex ^running
17972 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17973 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17974 running.
17975
17976 @item "^connected"
17977 @findex ^connected
17978 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17979
17980 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17981 @findex ^error
17982 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17983 error message.
17984
17985 @item "^exit"
17986 @findex ^exit
17987 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17988
17989 @end table
17990
17991 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17992 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17993
17994 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17995 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17996 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17997 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17998 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17999
18000 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18001 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18002 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18003 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18004 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18005
18006 @table @code
18007 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18008 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18009 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18010
18011 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18012 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18013 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18014 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18015
18016 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18017 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18018 internals.
18019 @end table
18020
18021 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
18022 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
18023
18024 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18025 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
18026 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18027 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18028 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18029 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18030
18031 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
18032 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
18033
18034 @table @code
18035 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18036 @end table
18037
18038 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
18039
18040 @table @code
18041 @item breakpoint-hit
18042 A breakpoint was reached.
18043 @item watchpoint-trigger
18044 A watchpoint was triggered.
18045 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18046 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18047 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18048 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18049 @item function-finished
18050 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18051 @item location-reached
18052 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18053 @item watchpoint-scope
18054 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18055 @item end-stepping-range
18056 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18057 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18058 @item exited-signalled
18059 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18060 @item exited
18061 The inferior exited.
18062 @item exited-normally
18063 The inferior exited normally.
18064 @item signal-received
18065 A signal was received by the inferior.
18066 @end table
18067
18068
18069 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18070 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18071 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18072 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18073
18074 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18075 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18076 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18077 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18078
18079 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18080 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18081
18082 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18083
18084 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18085 information of the breakpoint.
18086
18087 @smallexample
18088 -> -break-insert main
18089 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18090 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18091 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18092 <- (gdb)
18093 @end smallexample
18094
18095 @subheading Program Execution
18096
18097 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18098 reason that execution stopped.
18099
18100 @smallexample
18101 -> -exec-run
18102 <- ^running
18103 <- (gdb)
18104 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18105 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18106 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18107 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18108 <- (gdb)
18109 -> -exec-continue
18110 <- ^running
18111 <- (gdb)
18112 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18113 <- (gdb)
18114 @end smallexample
18115
18116 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18117
18118 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18119
18120 @smallexample
18121 -> (gdb)
18122 <- -gdb-exit
18123 <- ^exit
18124 @end smallexample
18125
18126 @subheading A Bad Command
18127
18128 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18129
18130 @smallexample
18131 -> -rubbish
18132 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18133 <- (gdb)
18134 @end smallexample
18135
18136
18137 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18138 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18139 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18140
18141 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18142 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18143
18144 @subheading Motivation
18145
18146 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18147
18148 @subheading Introduction
18149
18150 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18151
18152 @subheading Commands
18153
18154 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18155
18156 @subsubheading Synopsis
18157
18158 @smallexample
18159 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 @subsubheading Result
18163
18164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18165
18166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18167
18168 @subsubheading Example
18169
18170 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18171 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18172
18173
18174 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18175 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18176 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18177
18178 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18179 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18180 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18181 breakpoints.
18182
18183 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18184 @findex -break-after
18185
18186 @subsubheading Synopsis
18187
18188 @smallexample
18189 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18190 @end smallexample
18191
18192 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18193 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18194 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18195 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18196
18197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18198
18199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18200
18201 @subsubheading Example
18202
18203 @smallexample
18204 (gdb)
18205 -break-insert main
18206 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18207 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18208 (gdb)
18209 -break-after 1 3
18210 ~
18211 ^done
18212 (gdb)
18213 -break-list
18214 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18215 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18216 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18217 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18218 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18219 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18220 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18221 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18222 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18223 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18224 (gdb)
18225 @end smallexample
18226
18227 @ignore
18228 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18229 @findex -break-catch
18230
18231 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18232 @findex -break-commands
18233 @end ignore
18234
18235
18236 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18237 @findex -break-condition
18238
18239 @subsubheading Synopsis
18240
18241 @smallexample
18242 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18243 @end smallexample
18244
18245 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18246 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18247 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18248 command below).
18249
18250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18251
18252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18253
18254 @subsubheading Example
18255
18256 @smallexample
18257 (gdb)
18258 -break-condition 1 1
18259 ^done
18260 (gdb)
18261 -break-list
18262 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18263 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18264 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18265 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18266 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18267 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18268 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18269 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18270 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18271 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18272 (gdb)
18273 @end smallexample
18274
18275 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18276 @findex -break-delete
18277
18278 @subsubheading Synopsis
18279
18280 @smallexample
18281 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18285 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18286
18287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18288
18289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18290
18291 @subsubheading Example
18292
18293 @smallexample
18294 (gdb)
18295 -break-delete 1
18296 ^done
18297 (gdb)
18298 -break-list
18299 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18300 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18301 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18302 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18303 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18304 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18305 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18306 body=[]@}
18307 (gdb)
18308 @end smallexample
18309
18310 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18311 @findex -break-disable
18312
18313 @subsubheading Synopsis
18314
18315 @smallexample
18316 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18317 @end smallexample
18318
18319 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18320 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18321
18322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18323
18324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18325
18326 @subsubheading Example
18327
18328 @smallexample
18329 (gdb)
18330 -break-disable 2
18331 ^done
18332 (gdb)
18333 -break-list
18334 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18335 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18336 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18337 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18338 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18339 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18340 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18341 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18342 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18343 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18344 (gdb)
18345 @end smallexample
18346
18347 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18348 @findex -break-enable
18349
18350 @subsubheading Synopsis
18351
18352 @smallexample
18353 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18354 @end smallexample
18355
18356 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18357
18358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18359
18360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18361
18362 @subsubheading Example
18363
18364 @smallexample
18365 (gdb)
18366 -break-enable 2
18367 ^done
18368 (gdb)
18369 -break-list
18370 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18371 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18372 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18373 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18374 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18375 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18376 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18377 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18378 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18379 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18380 (gdb)
18381 @end smallexample
18382
18383 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18384 @findex -break-info
18385
18386 @subsubheading Synopsis
18387
18388 @smallexample
18389 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18390 @end smallexample
18391
18392 @c REDUNDANT???
18393 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18394
18395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18396
18397 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18398
18399 @subsubheading Example
18400 N.A.
18401
18402 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18403 @findex -break-insert
18404
18405 @subsubheading Synopsis
18406
18407 @smallexample
18408 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18409 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18410 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18411 @end smallexample
18412
18413 @noindent
18414 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18415
18416 @itemize @bullet
18417 @item function
18418 @c @item +offset
18419 @c @item -offset
18420 @c @item linenum
18421 @item filename:linenum
18422 @item filename:function
18423 @item *address
18424 @end itemize
18425
18426 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18427
18428 @table @samp
18429 @item -t
18430 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18431 @item -h
18432 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18433 @item -c @var{condition}
18434 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18435 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18436 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18437 @item -f
18438 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18439 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18440 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18441 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18442 cannot be parsed.
18443 @end table
18444
18445 @subsubheading Result
18446
18447 The result is in the form:
18448
18449 @smallexample
18450 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18451 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18452 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18453 times="@var{times}"@}
18454 @end smallexample
18455
18456 @noindent
18457 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18458 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18459 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18460 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18461 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18462 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18463 which use the same output).
18464
18465 Note: this format is open to change.
18466 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18467
18468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18469
18470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18471 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18472
18473 @subsubheading Example
18474
18475 @smallexample
18476 (gdb)
18477 -break-insert main
18478 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18479 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18480 (gdb)
18481 -break-insert -t foo
18482 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18483 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18484 (gdb)
18485 -break-list
18486 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18487 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18488 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18489 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18490 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18491 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18492 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18493 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18494 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18495 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18496 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18497 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18498 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18499 (gdb)
18500 -break-insert -r foo.*
18501 ~int foo(int, int);
18502 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18503 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18504 (gdb)
18505 @end smallexample
18506
18507 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18508 @findex -break-list
18509
18510 @subsubheading Synopsis
18511
18512 @smallexample
18513 -break-list
18514 @end smallexample
18515
18516 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18517
18518 @table @samp
18519 @item Number
18520 number of the breakpoint
18521 @item Type
18522 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18523 @item Disposition
18524 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18525 or @samp{nokeep}
18526 @item Enabled
18527 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18528 @item Address
18529 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18530 @item What
18531 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18532 name, line number
18533 @item Times
18534 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18535 @end table
18536
18537 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18538 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18539
18540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18541
18542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18543
18544 @subsubheading Example
18545
18546 @smallexample
18547 (gdb)
18548 -break-list
18549 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18550 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18551 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18552 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18553 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18554 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18555 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18556 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18557 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18558 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18559 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18560 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18561 (gdb)
18562 @end smallexample
18563
18564 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18565
18566 @smallexample
18567 (gdb)
18568 -break-list
18569 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18570 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18571 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18572 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18573 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18574 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18575 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18576 body=[]@}
18577 (gdb)
18578 @end smallexample
18579
18580 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18581 @findex -break-watch
18582
18583 @subsubheading Synopsis
18584
18585 @smallexample
18586 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18587 @end smallexample
18588
18589 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18590 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18591 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18592 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18593 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18594 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18595 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18596 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18597
18598 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18599 breakpoints inserted.
18600
18601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18602
18603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18604 @samp{rwatch}.
18605
18606 @subsubheading Example
18607
18608 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18609
18610 @smallexample
18611 (gdb)
18612 -break-watch x
18613 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18614 (gdb)
18615 -exec-continue
18616 ^running
18617 (gdb)
18618 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18619 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18620 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18621 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18622 (gdb)
18623 @end smallexample
18624
18625 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18626 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18627 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18628
18629 @smallexample
18630 (gdb)
18631 -break-watch C
18632 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18633 (gdb)
18634 -exec-continue
18635 ^running
18636 (gdb)
18637 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18638 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18639 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18640 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18641 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18642 (gdb)
18643 -exec-continue
18644 ^running
18645 (gdb)
18646 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18647 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18648 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18649 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18650 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18651 (gdb)
18652 @end smallexample
18653
18654 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18655 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18656 deleted.
18657
18658 @smallexample
18659 (gdb)
18660 -break-watch C
18661 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18662 (gdb)
18663 -break-list
18664 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18665 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18666 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18667 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18668 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18669 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18670 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18671 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18672 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18673 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18674 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18675 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18676 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18677 (gdb)
18678 -exec-continue
18679 ^running
18680 (gdb)
18681 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18682 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18683 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18684 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18685 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18686 (gdb)
18687 -break-list
18688 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18689 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18690 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18691 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18692 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18693 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18694 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18695 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18696 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18697 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18698 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18699 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18700 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18701 (gdb)
18702 -exec-continue
18703 ^running
18704 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18705 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18706 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18707 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18708 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18709 (gdb)
18710 -break-list
18711 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18712 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18713 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18714 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18715 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18716 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18717 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18718 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18719 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18720 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18721 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18722 times="1"@}]@}
18723 (gdb)
18724 @end smallexample
18725
18726 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18727 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18728 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18729
18730 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18731 @findex -exec-arguments
18732
18733
18734 @subsubheading Synopsis
18735
18736 @smallexample
18737 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18738 @end smallexample
18739
18740 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18741 @samp{-exec-run}.
18742
18743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18744
18745 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18746
18747 @subsubheading Example
18748
18749 @c FIXME!
18750 Don't have one around.
18751
18752
18753 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18754 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18755
18756 @subsubheading Synopsis
18757
18758 @smallexample
18759 -exec-show-arguments
18760 @end smallexample
18761
18762 Print the arguments of the program.
18763
18764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18765
18766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18767
18768 @subsubheading Example
18769 N.A.
18770
18771
18772 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18773 @findex -environment-cd
18774
18775 @subsubheading Synopsis
18776
18777 @smallexample
18778 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18779 @end smallexample
18780
18781 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18782
18783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18784
18785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18786
18787 @subsubheading Example
18788
18789 @smallexample
18790 (gdb)
18791 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18792 ^done
18793 (gdb)
18794 @end smallexample
18795
18796
18797 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18798 @findex -environment-directory
18799
18800 @subsubheading Synopsis
18801
18802 @smallexample
18803 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18807 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18808 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18809 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18810 occurs as normal.
18811 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18812 multiple directories in a single command
18813 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18814 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18815 If blanks are needed as
18816 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18817 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18818 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18819 character must not be used
18820 in any directory name.
18821 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18822
18823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18824
18825 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18826
18827 @subsubheading Example
18828
18829 @smallexample
18830 (gdb)
18831 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18832 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18833 (gdb)
18834 -environment-directory ""
18835 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18836 (gdb)
18837 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18838 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18839 (gdb)
18840 -environment-directory -r
18841 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18842 (gdb)
18843 @end smallexample
18844
18845
18846 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18847 @findex -environment-path
18848
18849 @subsubheading Synopsis
18850
18851 @smallexample
18852 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18853 @end smallexample
18854
18855 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18856 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18857 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18858 supplied in addition to the
18859 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18860 occurs as normal.
18861 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18862 multiple directories in a single command
18863 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18864 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18865 If blanks are needed as
18866 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18867 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18868 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18869 character must not be used
18870 in any directory name.
18871 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18872
18873
18874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18875
18876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18877
18878 @subsubheading Example
18879
18880 @smallexample
18881 (gdb)
18882 -environment-path
18883 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18884 (gdb)
18885 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18886 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18887 (gdb)
18888 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18889 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18890 (gdb)
18891 @end smallexample
18892
18893
18894 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18895 @findex -environment-pwd
18896
18897 @subsubheading Synopsis
18898
18899 @smallexample
18900 -environment-pwd
18901 @end smallexample
18902
18903 Show the current working directory.
18904
18905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18906
18907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18908
18909 @subsubheading Example
18910
18911 @smallexample
18912 (gdb)
18913 -environment-pwd
18914 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18915 (gdb)
18916 @end smallexample
18917
18918 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18919 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18920 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18921
18922
18923 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18924 @findex -thread-info
18925
18926 @subsubheading Synopsis
18927
18928 @smallexample
18929 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
18930 @end smallexample
18931
18932 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
18933 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
18934 threads. When printing information about all threads,
18935 also reports the current thread.
18936
18937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18938
18939 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
18940 about all threads.
18941
18942 @subsubheading Example
18943
18944 @smallexample
18945 -thread-info
18946 ^done,threads=[
18947 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
18948 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
18949 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
18950 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
18951 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
18952 current-thread-id="1"
18953 (gdb)
18954 @end smallexample
18955
18956 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18957 @findex -thread-list-ids
18958
18959 @subsubheading Synopsis
18960
18961 @smallexample
18962 -thread-list-ids
18963 @end smallexample
18964
18965 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18966 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18967
18968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18969
18970 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18971
18972 @subsubheading Example
18973
18974 No threads present, besides the main process:
18975
18976 @smallexample
18977 (gdb)
18978 -thread-list-ids
18979 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18980 (gdb)
18981 @end smallexample
18982
18983
18984 Several threads:
18985
18986 @smallexample
18987 (gdb)
18988 -thread-list-ids
18989 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18990 number-of-threads="3"
18991 (gdb)
18992 @end smallexample
18993
18994
18995 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18996 @findex -thread-select
18997
18998 @subsubheading Synopsis
18999
19000 @smallexample
19001 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19002 @end smallexample
19003
19004 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19005 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19006
19007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19008
19009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19010
19011 @subsubheading Example
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 (gdb)
19015 -exec-next
19016 ^running
19017 (gdb)
19018 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19019 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19020 (gdb)
19021 -thread-list-ids
19022 ^done,
19023 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19024 number-of-threads="3"
19025 (gdb)
19026 -thread-select 3
19027 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19028 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19029 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19030 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19031 (gdb)
19032 @end smallexample
19033
19034 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19035 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19036 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19037
19038 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19039 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19040 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19041 other cases.
19042
19043 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19044 @findex -exec-continue
19045
19046 @subsubheading Synopsis
19047
19048 @smallexample
19049 -exec-continue
19050 @end smallexample
19051
19052 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19053 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19054
19055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19056
19057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19058
19059 @subsubheading Example
19060
19061 @smallexample
19062 -exec-continue
19063 ^running
19064 (gdb)
19065 @@Hello world
19066 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
19067 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
19068 (gdb)
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071
19072 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19073 @findex -exec-finish
19074
19075 @subsubheading Synopsis
19076
19077 @smallexample
19078 -exec-finish
19079 @end smallexample
19080
19081 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19082 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19083
19084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19085
19086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19087
19088 @subsubheading Example
19089
19090 Function returning @code{void}.
19091
19092 @smallexample
19093 -exec-finish
19094 ^running
19095 (gdb)
19096 @@hello from foo
19097 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19098 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19099 (gdb)
19100 @end smallexample
19101
19102 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19103 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19104 value itself.
19105
19106 @smallexample
19107 -exec-finish
19108 ^running
19109 (gdb)
19110 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19111 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19112 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19113 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19114 (gdb)
19115 @end smallexample
19116
19117
19118 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19119 @findex -exec-interrupt
19120
19121 @subsubheading Synopsis
19122
19123 @smallexample
19124 -exec-interrupt
19125 @end smallexample
19126
19127 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19128 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19129 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19130 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19131 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19132
19133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19134
19135 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19136
19137 @subsubheading Example
19138
19139 @smallexample
19140 (gdb)
19141 111-exec-continue
19142 111^running
19143
19144 (gdb)
19145 222-exec-interrupt
19146 222^done
19147 (gdb)
19148 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19149 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19150 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19151 (gdb)
19152
19153 (gdb)
19154 -exec-interrupt
19155 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19156 (gdb)
19157 @end smallexample
19158
19159
19160 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19161 @findex -exec-next
19162
19163 @subsubheading Synopsis
19164
19165 @smallexample
19166 -exec-next
19167 @end smallexample
19168
19169 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19170 of the next source line is reached.
19171
19172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19173
19174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19175
19176 @subsubheading Example
19177
19178 @smallexample
19179 -exec-next
19180 ^running
19181 (gdb)
19182 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19183 (gdb)
19184 @end smallexample
19185
19186
19187 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19188 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19189
19190 @subsubheading Synopsis
19191
19192 @smallexample
19193 -exec-next-instruction
19194 @end smallexample
19195
19196 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19197 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19198 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19199 printed as well.
19200
19201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19202
19203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19204
19205 @subsubheading Example
19206
19207 @smallexample
19208 (gdb)
19209 -exec-next-instruction
19210 ^running
19211
19212 (gdb)
19213 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19214 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19215 (gdb)
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218
19219 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19220 @findex -exec-return
19221
19222 @subsubheading Synopsis
19223
19224 @smallexample
19225 -exec-return
19226 @end smallexample
19227
19228 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19229 Displays the new current frame.
19230
19231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19232
19233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19234
19235 @subsubheading Example
19236
19237 @smallexample
19238 (gdb)
19239 200-break-insert callee4
19240 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19241 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19242 (gdb)
19243 000-exec-run
19244 000^running
19245 (gdb)
19246 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19247 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19248 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19249 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19250 (gdb)
19251 205-break-delete
19252 205^done
19253 (gdb)
19254 111-exec-return
19255 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19256 args=[@{name="strarg",
19257 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19258 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19259 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19260 (gdb)
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263
19264 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19265 @findex -exec-run
19266
19267 @subsubheading Synopsis
19268
19269 @smallexample
19270 -exec-run
19271 @end smallexample
19272
19273 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19274 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19275 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19276 the program has exited exceptionally.
19277
19278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19279
19280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19281
19282 @subsubheading Examples
19283
19284 @smallexample
19285 (gdb)
19286 -break-insert main
19287 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19288 (gdb)
19289 -exec-run
19290 ^running
19291 (gdb)
19292 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19293 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19294 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19295 (gdb)
19296 @end smallexample
19297
19298 @noindent
19299 Program exited normally:
19300
19301 @smallexample
19302 (gdb)
19303 -exec-run
19304 ^running
19305 (gdb)
19306 x = 55
19307 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19308 (gdb)
19309 @end smallexample
19310
19311 @noindent
19312 Program exited exceptionally:
19313
19314 @smallexample
19315 (gdb)
19316 -exec-run
19317 ^running
19318 (gdb)
19319 x = 55
19320 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19321 (gdb)
19322 @end smallexample
19323
19324 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19325 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19326
19327 @smallexample
19328 (gdb)
19329 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19330 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19331 @end smallexample
19332
19333
19334 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19335
19336
19337 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19338 @findex -exec-step
19339
19340 @subsubheading Synopsis
19341
19342 @smallexample
19343 -exec-step
19344 @end smallexample
19345
19346 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19347 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19348 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19349 function.
19350
19351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19352
19353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19354
19355 @subsubheading Example
19356
19357 Stepping into a function:
19358
19359 @smallexample
19360 -exec-step
19361 ^running
19362 (gdb)
19363 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19364 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19365 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19366 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19367 (gdb)
19368 @end smallexample
19369
19370 Regular stepping:
19371
19372 @smallexample
19373 -exec-step
19374 ^running
19375 (gdb)
19376 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19377 (gdb)
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380
19381 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19382 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19383
19384 @subsubheading Synopsis
19385
19386 @smallexample
19387 -exec-step-instruction
19388 @end smallexample
19389
19390 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19391 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19392 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19393 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19394 well.
19395
19396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19397
19398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19399
19400 @subsubheading Example
19401
19402 @smallexample
19403 (gdb)
19404 -exec-step-instruction
19405 ^running
19406
19407 (gdb)
19408 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19409 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19410 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19411 (gdb)
19412 -exec-step-instruction
19413 ^running
19414
19415 (gdb)
19416 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19417 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19418 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19419 (gdb)
19420 @end smallexample
19421
19422
19423 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19424 @findex -exec-until
19425
19426 @subsubheading Synopsis
19427
19428 @smallexample
19429 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19430 @end smallexample
19431
19432 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19433 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19434 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19435 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19436
19437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19438
19439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19440
19441 @subsubheading Example
19442
19443 @smallexample
19444 (gdb)
19445 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19446 ^running
19447 (gdb)
19448 x = 55
19449 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19450 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19451 (gdb)
19452 @end smallexample
19453
19454 @ignore
19455 @subheading -file-clear
19456 Is this going away????
19457 @end ignore
19458
19459 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19460 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19461 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19462
19463
19464 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19465 @findex -stack-info-frame
19466
19467 @subsubheading Synopsis
19468
19469 @smallexample
19470 -stack-info-frame
19471 @end smallexample
19472
19473 Get info on the selected frame.
19474
19475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19476
19477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19478 (without arguments).
19479
19480 @subsubheading Example
19481
19482 @smallexample
19483 (gdb)
19484 -stack-info-frame
19485 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19488 (gdb)
19489 @end smallexample
19490
19491 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19492 @findex -stack-info-depth
19493
19494 @subsubheading Synopsis
19495
19496 @smallexample
19497 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19498 @end smallexample
19499
19500 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19501 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19502
19503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19504
19505 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19506
19507 @subsubheading Example
19508
19509 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19510
19511 @smallexample
19512 (gdb)
19513 -stack-info-depth
19514 ^done,depth="12"
19515 (gdb)
19516 -stack-info-depth 4
19517 ^done,depth="4"
19518 (gdb)
19519 -stack-info-depth 12
19520 ^done,depth="12"
19521 (gdb)
19522 -stack-info-depth 11
19523 ^done,depth="11"
19524 (gdb)
19525 -stack-info-depth 13
19526 ^done,depth="12"
19527 (gdb)
19528 @end smallexample
19529
19530 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19531 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19532
19533 @subsubheading Synopsis
19534
19535 @smallexample
19536 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19537 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19538 @end smallexample
19539
19540 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19541 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19542 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19543 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19544 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19545 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19546 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19547 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19548
19549 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19550 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19551 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19552
19553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19554
19555 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19556 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19557 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19558
19559 @subsubheading Example
19560
19561 @smallexample
19562 (gdb)
19563 -stack-list-frames
19564 ^done,
19565 stack=[
19566 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19567 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19568 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19569 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19570 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19571 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19572 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19573 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19574 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19575 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19576 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19577 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19578 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19579 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19580 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19581 (gdb)
19582 -stack-list-arguments 0
19583 ^done,
19584 stack-args=[
19585 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19586 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19587 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19588 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19589 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19590 (gdb)
19591 -stack-list-arguments 1
19592 ^done,
19593 stack-args=[
19594 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19595 frame=@{level="1",
19596 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19597 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19598 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19599 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19600 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19601 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19602 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19603 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19604 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19605 (gdb)
19606 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19607 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19608 (gdb)
19609 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19610 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19611 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19612 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19613 (gdb)
19614 @end smallexample
19615
19616 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19617
19618
19619 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19620 @findex -stack-list-frames
19621
19622 @subsubheading Synopsis
19623
19624 @smallexample
19625 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19626 @end smallexample
19627
19628 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19629 following info:
19630
19631 @table @samp
19632 @item @var{level}
19633 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19634 @item @var{addr}
19635 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19636 @item @var{func}
19637 Function name.
19638 @item @var{file}
19639 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19640 @item @var{line}
19641 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19642 @end table
19643
19644 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19645 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19646 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19647 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19648 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19649 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19650 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19651
19652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19653
19654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19655
19656 @subsubheading Example
19657
19658 Full stack backtrace:
19659
19660 @smallexample
19661 (gdb)
19662 -stack-list-frames
19663 ^done,stack=
19664 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19665 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19666 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19667 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19668 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19669 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19670 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19671 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19672 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19673 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19674 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19675 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19676 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19677 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19678 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19679 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19680 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19681 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19682 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19683 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19684 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19685 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19686 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19687 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19688 (gdb)
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 (gdb)
19695 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19696 ^done,stack=
19697 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19698 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19699 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19700 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19701 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19702 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19703 (gdb)
19704 @end smallexample
19705
19706 Show a single frame:
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 (gdb)
19710 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19711 ^done,stack=
19712 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19713 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19714 (gdb)
19715 @end smallexample
19716
19717
19718 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19719 @findex -stack-list-locals
19720
19721 @subsubheading Synopsis
19722
19723 @smallexample
19724 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19725 @end smallexample
19726
19727 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19728 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19729 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19730 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19731 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19732 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19733 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19734 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19735 more detail.
19736
19737 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19738
19739 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19740
19741 @subsubheading Example
19742
19743 @smallexample
19744 (gdb)
19745 -stack-list-locals 0
19746 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19747 (gdb)
19748 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19749 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19750 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19751 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19752 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19753 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19754 (gdb)
19755 @end smallexample
19756
19757
19758 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19759 @findex -stack-select-frame
19760
19761 @subsubheading Synopsis
19762
19763 @smallexample
19764 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19768 the stack.
19769
19770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19771
19772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19773 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19774
19775 @subsubheading Example
19776
19777 @smallexample
19778 (gdb)
19779 -stack-select-frame 2
19780 ^done
19781 (gdb)
19782 @end smallexample
19783
19784 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19785 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19786 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19787
19788 @ignore
19789
19790 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19791
19792 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19793 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19794 used by @code{Insight}.
19795
19796 The two main reasons for that are:
19797
19798 @enumerate 1
19799 @item
19800 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19801
19802 @item
19803 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19804 now).
19805 @end enumerate
19806
19807 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19808 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19809 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19810 hints about their use.
19811
19812 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19813 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19814 least, the following operations:
19815
19816 @itemize @bullet
19817 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19818 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19819 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19820 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19821 @end itemize
19822
19823 @end ignore
19824
19825 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19826
19827 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19828
19829 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19830 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19831 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19832 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19833 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19834 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19835 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19836 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19837 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19838 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19839 object, or to change display format.
19840
19841 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19842 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19843 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19844 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19845 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19846 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19847 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19848 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19849 child will be created.
19850
19851 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19852 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19853 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19854 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19855 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19856
19857 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19858 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19859 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19860 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19861 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19862 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19863 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19864 variables that frontend has created.
19865
19866 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19867 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19868 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19869 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19870 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19871 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19872 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19873 implicitly updated.
19874
19875 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19876 access this functionality:
19877
19878 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19879 @item @strong{Operation}
19880 @tab @strong{Description}
19881
19882 @item @code{-var-create}
19883 @tab create a variable object
19884 @item @code{-var-delete}
19885 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19886 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19887 @tab set the display format of this variable
19888 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19889 @tab show the display format of this variable
19890 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19891 @tab tells how many children this object has
19892 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19893 @tab return a list of the object's children
19894 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19895 @tab show the type of this variable object
19896 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19897 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19898 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19899 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19900 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19901 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19902 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19903 @tab get the value of this variable
19904 @item @code{-var-assign}
19905 @tab set the value of this variable
19906 @item @code{-var-update}
19907 @tab update the variable and its children
19908 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19909 @tab set frozeness attribute
19910 @end multitable
19911
19912 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19913 how it can be used.
19914
19915 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19916
19917 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19918 @findex -var-create
19919
19920 @subsubheading Synopsis
19921
19922 @smallexample
19923 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19924 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19925 @end smallexample
19926
19927 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19928 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19929 register.
19930
19931 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19932 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19933 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19934 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19935 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19936
19937 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19938 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19939 frame should be used.
19940
19941 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19942 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19943
19944 @itemize @bullet
19945 @item
19946 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19947
19948 @item
19949 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19950
19951 @item
19952 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19953 @end itemize
19954
19955 @subsubheading Result
19956
19957 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19958 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19959 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19960
19961 @smallexample
19962 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19963 @end smallexample
19964
19965
19966 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19967 @findex -var-delete
19968
19969 @subsubheading Synopsis
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19973 @end smallexample
19974
19975 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19976 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19977
19978 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19979
19980
19981 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19982 @findex -var-set-format
19983
19984 @subsubheading Synopsis
19985
19986 @smallexample
19987 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19988 @end smallexample
19989
19990 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19991 @var{format-spec}.
19992
19993 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19994
19995 @smallexample
19996 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19997 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19998 @end smallexample
19999
20000 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20001 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20002 for pointers, etc.).
20003
20004 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20005 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20006
20007 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20008 @findex -var-show-format
20009
20010 @subsubheading Synopsis
20011
20012 @smallexample
20013 -var-show-format @var{name}
20014 @end smallexample
20015
20016 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20017
20018 @smallexample
20019 @var{format} @expansion{}
20020 @var{format-spec}
20021 @end smallexample
20022
20023
20024 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20025 @findex -var-info-num-children
20026
20027 @subsubheading Synopsis
20028
20029 @smallexample
20030 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20031 @end smallexample
20032
20033 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20034
20035 @smallexample
20036 numchild=@var{n}
20037 @end smallexample
20038
20039
20040 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20041 @findex -var-list-children
20042
20043 @subsubheading Synopsis
20044
20045 @smallexample
20046 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20047 @end smallexample
20048 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20049
20050 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20051 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20052 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20053 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20054 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20055 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20056 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20057 and unions.
20058
20059 @subsubheading Example
20060
20061 @smallexample
20062 (gdb)
20063 -var-list-children n
20064 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20065 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20066 (gdb)
20067 -var-list-children --all-values n
20068 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20069 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20070 @end smallexample
20071
20072
20073 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20074 @findex -var-info-type
20075
20076 @subsubheading Synopsis
20077
20078 @smallexample
20079 -var-info-type @var{name}
20080 @end smallexample
20081
20082 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20083 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20084 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20085
20086 @smallexample
20087 type=@var{typename}
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090
20091 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20092 @findex -var-info-expression
20093
20094 @subsubheading Synopsis
20095
20096 @smallexample
20097 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20098 @end smallexample
20099
20100 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20101 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20102 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20103
20104 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20105 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20106
20107 @smallexample
20108 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20109 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20110 @end smallexample
20111
20112 @noindent
20113 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20114
20115 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20116 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20117 is of limited use.
20118
20119 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20120 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20121
20122 @subsubheading Synopsis
20123
20124 @smallexample
20125 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20126 @end smallexample
20127
20128 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20129 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20130 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20131 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20132 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20133 watchpoint from a variable object.
20134
20135 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20136 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20137 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20138 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20139 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20140 @smallexample
20141 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20142 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20143 @end smallexample
20144
20145 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20146 @findex -var-show-attributes
20147
20148 @subsubheading Synopsis
20149
20150 @smallexample
20151 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20155
20156 @smallexample
20157 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20158 @end smallexample
20159
20160 @noindent
20161 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20162
20163 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20164 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20165
20166 @subsubheading Synopsis
20167
20168 @smallexample
20169 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
20170 @end smallexample
20171
20172 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20173 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
20174 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20175
20176 @smallexample
20177 value=@var{value}
20178 @end smallexample
20179
20180 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20181 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20182
20183 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20184 @findex -var-assign
20185
20186 @subsubheading Synopsis
20187
20188 @smallexample
20189 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20190 @end smallexample
20191
20192 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20193 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20194 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20195 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20196
20197 @subsubheading Example
20198
20199 @smallexample
20200 (gdb)
20201 -var-assign var1 3
20202 ^done,value="3"
20203 (gdb)
20204 -var-update *
20205 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20206 (gdb)
20207 @end smallexample
20208
20209 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20210 @findex -var-update
20211
20212 @subsubheading Synopsis
20213
20214 @smallexample
20215 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20216 @end smallexample
20217
20218 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20219 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20220 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20221 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20222 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20223 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20224 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20225 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20226 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20227 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20228 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20229 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20230 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20231
20232
20233 @subsubheading Example
20234
20235 @smallexample
20236 (gdb)
20237 -var-assign var1 3
20238 ^done,value="3"
20239 (gdb)
20240 -var-update --all-values var1
20241 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20242 type_changed="false"@}]
20243 (gdb)
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246 @anchor{-var-update}
20247 The field in_scope may take three values:
20248
20249 @table @code
20250 @item "true"
20251 The variable object's current value is valid.
20252
20253 @item "false"
20254 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20255 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20256 scope.
20257
20258 @item "invalid"
20259 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20260 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20261 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20262 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20263 objects.
20264 @end table
20265
20266 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20267 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20268
20269 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20270 @findex -var-set-frozen
20271 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20272
20273 @subsubheading Synopsis
20274
20275 @smallexample
20276 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20277 @end smallexample
20278
20279 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20280 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20281 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20282 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20283 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20284 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20285 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20286 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20287 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20288 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20289 @code{-var-update} does.
20290
20291 @subsubheading Example
20292
20293 @smallexample
20294 (gdb)
20295 -var-set-frozen V 1
20296 ^done
20297 (gdb)
20298 @end smallexample
20299
20300
20301 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20302 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20303 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20304
20305 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20306 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20307 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20308 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20309
20310 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20311 @c @subheading -data-assign
20312 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20313 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20314 @c set variable
20315 @c @subsubheading Example
20316 @c N.A.
20317
20318 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20319 @findex -data-disassemble
20320
20321 @subsubheading Synopsis
20322
20323 @smallexample
20324 -data-disassemble
20325 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20326 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20327 -- @var{mode}
20328 @end smallexample
20329
20330 @noindent
20331 Where:
20332
20333 @table @samp
20334 @item @var{start-addr}
20335 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20336 @item @var{end-addr}
20337 is the end address
20338 @item @var{filename}
20339 is the name of the file to disassemble
20340 @item @var{linenum}
20341 is the line number to disassemble around
20342 @item @var{lines}
20343 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20344 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20345 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20346 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20347 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20348 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20349 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20350 are displayed.
20351 @item @var{mode}
20352 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20353 disassembly).
20354 @end table
20355
20356 @subsubheading Result
20357
20358 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20359
20360 @itemize @bullet
20361 @item Address
20362 @item Func-name
20363 @item Offset
20364 @item Instruction
20365 @end itemize
20366
20367 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20368 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20369
20370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20371
20372 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20373
20374 @subsubheading Example
20375
20376 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20377
20378 @smallexample
20379 (gdb)
20380 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20381 ^done,
20382 asm_insns=[
20383 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20384 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20385 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20386 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20387 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20388 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20389 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20390 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20391 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20392 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20393 (gdb)
20394 @end smallexample
20395
20396 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20397 @code{main}.
20398
20399 @smallexample
20400 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20401 ^done,asm_insns=[
20402 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20403 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20404 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20405 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20406 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20407 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20408 [@dots{}]
20409 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20410 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20411 (gdb)
20412 @end smallexample
20413
20414 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20415
20416 @smallexample
20417 (gdb)
20418 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20419 ^done,asm_insns=[
20420 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20421 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20422 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20423 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20424 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20425 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20426 (gdb)
20427 @end smallexample
20428
20429 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20430
20431 @smallexample
20432 (gdb)
20433 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20434 ^done,asm_insns=[
20435 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20436 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20437 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20438 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20439 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20440 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20441 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20442 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20443 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20444 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20445 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20446 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20447 (gdb)
20448 @end smallexample
20449
20450
20451 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20452 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20453
20454 @subsubheading Synopsis
20455
20456 @smallexample
20457 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20458 @end smallexample
20459
20460 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20461 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20462 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20463
20464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20465
20466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20467 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20468 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20469
20470 @subsubheading Example
20471
20472 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20473 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20474 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20475 output.
20476
20477 @smallexample
20478 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20479 211^done,value="1"
20480 (gdb)
20481 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20482 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20483 (gdb)
20484 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20485 411^done,value="4"
20486 (gdb)
20487 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20488 511^done,value="4"
20489 (gdb)
20490 @end smallexample
20491
20492
20493 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20494 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20495
20496 @subsubheading Synopsis
20497
20498 @smallexample
20499 -data-list-changed-registers
20500 @end smallexample
20501
20502 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20503
20504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20505
20506 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20507 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20508
20509 @subsubheading Example
20510
20511 On a PPC MBX board:
20512
20513 @smallexample
20514 (gdb)
20515 -exec-continue
20516 ^running
20517
20518 (gdb)
20519 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20520 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20521 (gdb)
20522 -data-list-changed-registers
20523 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20524 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20525 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20526 (gdb)
20527 @end smallexample
20528
20529
20530 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20531 @findex -data-list-register-names
20532
20533 @subsubheading Synopsis
20534
20535 @smallexample
20536 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20537 @end smallexample
20538
20539 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20540 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20541 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20542 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20543 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20544 include empty register names.
20545
20546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20547
20548 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20549 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20550 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20551
20552 @subsubheading Example
20553
20554 For the PPC MBX board:
20555 @smallexample
20556 (gdb)
20557 -data-list-register-names
20558 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20559 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20560 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20561 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20562 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20563 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20564 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20565 (gdb)
20566 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20567 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20568 (gdb)
20569 @end smallexample
20570
20571 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20572 @findex -data-list-register-values
20573
20574 @subsubheading Synopsis
20575
20576 @smallexample
20577 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20578 @end smallexample
20579
20580 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20581 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20582 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20583 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20584
20585 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20586
20587 @table @code
20588 @item x
20589 Hexadecimal
20590 @item o
20591 Octal
20592 @item t
20593 Binary
20594 @item d
20595 Decimal
20596 @item r
20597 Raw
20598 @item N
20599 Natural
20600 @end table
20601
20602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20603
20604 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20605 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20606
20607 @subsubheading Example
20608
20609 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20610 don't appear in the actual output):
20611
20612 @smallexample
20613 (gdb)
20614 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20615 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20616 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20617 (gdb)
20618 -data-list-register-values x
20619 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20620 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20621 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20622 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20623 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20624 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20625 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20626 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20627 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20628 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20629 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20630 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20631 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20632 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20633 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20634 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20635 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20636 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20637 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20638 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20639 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20640 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20641 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20642 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20643 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20644 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20645 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20646 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20647 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20648 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20649 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20650 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20651 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20652 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20653 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20654 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20655 (gdb)
20656 @end smallexample
20657
20658
20659 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20660 @findex -data-read-memory
20661
20662 @subsubheading Synopsis
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20666 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20667 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670 @noindent
20671 where:
20672
20673 @table @samp
20674 @item @var{address}
20675 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20676 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20677 quoted using the C convention.
20678
20679 @item @var{word-format}
20680 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20681 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20682 ,Output Formats}).
20683
20684 @item @var{word-size}
20685 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20686
20687 @item @var{nr-rows}
20688 The number of rows in the output table.
20689
20690 @item @var{nr-cols}
20691 The number of columns in the output table.
20692
20693 @item @var{aschar}
20694 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20695 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20696 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20697 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20698
20699 @item @var{byte-offset}
20700 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20701 @end table
20702
20703 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20704 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20705 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20706 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20707 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20708 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20709 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20710 @samp{addr}.
20711
20712 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20713 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20714 @samp{prev-page}.
20715
20716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20717
20718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20719 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20720
20721 @subsubheading Example
20722
20723 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20724 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20725 word. Display each word in hex.
20726
20727 @smallexample
20728 (gdb)
20729 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20730 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20731 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20732 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20733 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20734 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20735 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20736 (gdb)
20737 @end smallexample
20738
20739 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20740 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20741
20742 @smallexample
20743 (gdb)
20744 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20745 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20746 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20747 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20748 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20749 (gdb)
20750 @end smallexample
20751
20752 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20753 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20754 used as the non-printable character.
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 (gdb)
20758 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20759 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20760 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20761 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20762 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20763 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20764 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20765 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20766 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20767 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20768 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20769 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20770 (gdb)
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20774 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20776
20777 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20778
20779 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20780
20781 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20782
20783 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20784
20785 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20786
20787 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20788
20789 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20790
20791 @c @subheading -trace-find
20792
20793 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20794
20795 @c @subheading -trace-info
20796
20797 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20798
20799 @c @subheading -trace-list
20800
20801 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20802
20803 @c @subheading -trace-save
20804
20805 @c @subheading -trace-start
20806
20807 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20808
20809
20810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20811 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20813
20814
20815 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20816 @findex -symbol-info-address
20817
20818 @subsubheading Synopsis
20819
20820 @smallexample
20821 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20822 @end smallexample
20823
20824 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20825
20826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20827
20828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20829
20830 @subsubheading Example
20831 N.A.
20832
20833
20834 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20835 @findex -symbol-info-file
20836
20837 @subsubheading Synopsis
20838
20839 @smallexample
20840 -symbol-info-file
20841 @end smallexample
20842
20843 Show the file for the symbol.
20844
20845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20846
20847 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20848 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20849
20850 @subsubheading Example
20851 N.A.
20852
20853
20854 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20855 @findex -symbol-info-function
20856
20857 @subsubheading Synopsis
20858
20859 @smallexample
20860 -symbol-info-function
20861 @end smallexample
20862
20863 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20864
20865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20866
20867 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20868
20869 @subsubheading Example
20870 N.A.
20871
20872
20873 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20874 @findex -symbol-info-line
20875
20876 @subsubheading Synopsis
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 -symbol-info-line
20880 @end smallexample
20881
20882 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20883
20884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20885
20886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20887 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20888
20889 @subsubheading Example
20890 N.A.
20891
20892
20893 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20894 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20895
20896 @subsubheading Synopsis
20897
20898 @smallexample
20899 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20900 @end smallexample
20901
20902 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20903
20904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20905
20906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20907
20908 @subsubheading Example
20909 N.A.
20910
20911
20912 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20913 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20914
20915 @subsubheading Synopsis
20916
20917 @smallexample
20918 -symbol-list-functions
20919 @end smallexample
20920
20921 List the functions in the executable.
20922
20923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20924
20925 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20926 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20927
20928 @subsubheading Example
20929 N.A.
20930
20931
20932 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20933 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20934
20935 @subsubheading Synopsis
20936
20937 @smallexample
20938 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20939 @end smallexample
20940
20941 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20942 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20943 ascending PC order.
20944
20945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20946
20947 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20948
20949 @subsubheading Example
20950 @smallexample
20951 (gdb)
20952 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20953 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20954 (gdb)
20955 @end smallexample
20956
20957
20958 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20959 @findex -symbol-list-types
20960
20961 @subsubheading Synopsis
20962
20963 @smallexample
20964 -symbol-list-types
20965 @end smallexample
20966
20967 List all the type names.
20968
20969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20970
20971 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20972 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20973
20974 @subsubheading Example
20975 N.A.
20976
20977
20978 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20979 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20980
20981 @subsubheading Synopsis
20982
20983 @smallexample
20984 -symbol-list-variables
20985 @end smallexample
20986
20987 List all the global and static variable names.
20988
20989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20990
20991 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20992
20993 @subsubheading Example
20994 N.A.
20995
20996
20997 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20998 @findex -symbol-locate
20999
21000 @subsubheading Synopsis
21001
21002 @smallexample
21003 -symbol-locate
21004 @end smallexample
21005
21006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21007
21008 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21009
21010 @subsubheading Example
21011 N.A.
21012
21013
21014 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21015 @findex -symbol-type
21016
21017 @subsubheading Synopsis
21018
21019 @smallexample
21020 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21021 @end smallexample
21022
21023 Show type of @var{variable}.
21024
21025 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21026
21027 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21028 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21029
21030 @subsubheading Example
21031 N.A.
21032
21033
21034 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21035 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21036 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21037
21038 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21039 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21040
21041 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21042 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21043
21044 @subsubheading Synopsis
21045
21046 @smallexample
21047 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21048 @end smallexample
21049
21050 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21051 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21052 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21053 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21054 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21055 notification.
21056
21057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21058
21059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21060
21061 @subsubheading Example
21062
21063 @smallexample
21064 (gdb)
21065 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21066 ^done
21067 (gdb)
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070
21071 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21072 @findex -file-exec-file
21073
21074 @subsubheading Synopsis
21075
21076 @smallexample
21077 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21078 @end smallexample
21079
21080 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21081 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21082 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21083 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21084 notification.
21085
21086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21087
21088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21089
21090 @subsubheading Example
21091
21092 @smallexample
21093 (gdb)
21094 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21095 ^done
21096 (gdb)
21097 @end smallexample
21098
21099
21100 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21101 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21102
21103 @subsubheading Synopsis
21104
21105 @smallexample
21106 -file-list-exec-sections
21107 @end smallexample
21108
21109 List the sections of the current executable file.
21110
21111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21112
21113 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21114 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21115 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21116
21117 @subsubheading Example
21118 N.A.
21119
21120
21121 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21122 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21123
21124 @subsubheading Synopsis
21125
21126 @smallexample
21127 -file-list-exec-source-file
21128 @end smallexample
21129
21130 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21131 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21132 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21133 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21134
21135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21136
21137 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21138
21139 @subsubheading Example
21140
21141 @smallexample
21142 (gdb)
21143 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21144 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21145 (gdb)
21146 @end smallexample
21147
21148
21149 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21150 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21151
21152 @subsubheading Synopsis
21153
21154 @smallexample
21155 -file-list-exec-source-files
21156 @end smallexample
21157
21158 List the source files for the current executable.
21159
21160 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21161 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21162
21163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21164
21165 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21166 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21167
21168 @subsubheading Example
21169 @smallexample
21170 (gdb)
21171 -file-list-exec-source-files
21172 ^done,files=[
21173 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21174 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21175 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21176 (gdb)
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21180 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21181
21182 @subsubheading Synopsis
21183
21184 @smallexample
21185 -file-list-shared-libraries
21186 @end smallexample
21187
21188 List the shared libraries in the program.
21189
21190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21191
21192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21193
21194 @subsubheading Example
21195 N.A.
21196
21197
21198 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21199 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21200
21201 @subsubheading Synopsis
21202
21203 @smallexample
21204 -file-list-symbol-files
21205 @end smallexample
21206
21207 List symbol files.
21208
21209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21210
21211 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21212
21213 @subsubheading Example
21214 N.A.
21215
21216
21217 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21218 @findex -file-symbol-file
21219
21220 @subsubheading Synopsis
21221
21222 @smallexample
21223 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21224 @end smallexample
21225
21226 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21227 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21228 produced, except for a completion notification.
21229
21230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21231
21232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21233
21234 @subsubheading Example
21235
21236 @smallexample
21237 (gdb)
21238 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21239 ^done
21240 (gdb)
21241 @end smallexample
21242
21243 @ignore
21244 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21245 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21246 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21247
21248 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21249
21250 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21251
21252 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21253
21254 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21255
21256 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21257
21258 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21259
21260 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21261
21262 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21263
21264 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21265 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21266 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21267
21268 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21269
21270 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21271
21272 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21273
21274 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21275 @end ignore
21276
21277
21278 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21279 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21280 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21281
21282
21283 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21284 @findex -target-attach
21285
21286 @subsubheading Synopsis
21287
21288 @smallexample
21289 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21290 @end smallexample
21291
21292 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21293
21294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21295
21296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21297
21298 @subsubheading Example
21299 N.A.
21300
21301
21302 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21303 @findex -target-compare-sections
21304
21305 @subsubheading Synopsis
21306
21307 @smallexample
21308 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21309 @end smallexample
21310
21311 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21312 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21313
21314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21315
21316 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21317
21318 @subsubheading Example
21319 N.A.
21320
21321
21322 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21323 @findex -target-detach
21324
21325 @subsubheading Synopsis
21326
21327 @smallexample
21328 -target-detach
21329 @end smallexample
21330
21331 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21332 There's no output.
21333
21334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21335
21336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21337
21338 @subsubheading Example
21339
21340 @smallexample
21341 (gdb)
21342 -target-detach
21343 ^done
21344 (gdb)
21345 @end smallexample
21346
21347
21348 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21349 @findex -target-disconnect
21350
21351 @subsubheading Synopsis
21352
21353 @smallexample
21354 -target-disconnect
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21358 generally not resumed.
21359
21360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21361
21362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21363
21364 @subsubheading Example
21365
21366 @smallexample
21367 (gdb)
21368 -target-disconnect
21369 ^done
21370 (gdb)
21371 @end smallexample
21372
21373
21374 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21375 @findex -target-download
21376
21377 @subsubheading Synopsis
21378
21379 @smallexample
21380 -target-download
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21384 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21385
21386 @table @samp
21387 @item section
21388 The name of the section.
21389 @item section-sent
21390 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21391 @item section-size
21392 The size of the section.
21393 @item total-sent
21394 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21395 @item total-size
21396 The size of the overall executable to download.
21397 @end table
21398
21399 @noindent
21400 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21401 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21402
21403 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21404 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21405
21406 @table @samp
21407 @item section
21408 The name of the section.
21409 @item section-size
21410 The size of the section.
21411 @item total-size
21412 The size of the overall executable to download.
21413 @end table
21414
21415 @noindent
21416 At the end, a summary is printed.
21417
21418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21419
21420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21421
21422 @subsubheading Example
21423
21424 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21425 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21426
21427 @smallexample
21428 (gdb)
21429 -target-download
21430 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21431 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21432 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21433 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21434 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21435 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21436 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21437 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21438 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21439 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21440 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21441 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21442 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21443 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21444 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21445 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21446 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21447 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21448 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21449 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21450 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21451 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21452 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21453 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21454 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21455 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21456 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21457 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21458 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21459 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21460 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21461 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21462 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21463 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21464 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21465 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21466 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21467 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21468 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21469 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21470 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21471 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21472 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21473 write-rate="429"
21474 (gdb)
21475 @end smallexample
21476
21477
21478 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21479 @findex -target-exec-status
21480
21481 @subsubheading Synopsis
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 -target-exec-status
21485 @end smallexample
21486
21487 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21488 not, for instance).
21489
21490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21491
21492 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21493
21494 @subsubheading Example
21495 N.A.
21496
21497
21498 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21499 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21500
21501 @subsubheading Synopsis
21502
21503 @smallexample
21504 -target-list-available-targets
21505 @end smallexample
21506
21507 List the possible targets to connect to.
21508
21509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21510
21511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21512
21513 @subsubheading Example
21514 N.A.
21515
21516
21517 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21518 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21519
21520 @subsubheading Synopsis
21521
21522 @smallexample
21523 -target-list-current-targets
21524 @end smallexample
21525
21526 Describe the current target.
21527
21528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21529
21530 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21531 other things).
21532
21533 @subsubheading Example
21534 N.A.
21535
21536
21537 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21538 @findex -target-list-parameters
21539
21540 @subsubheading Synopsis
21541
21542 @smallexample
21543 -target-list-parameters
21544 @end smallexample
21545
21546 @c ????
21547
21548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21549
21550 No equivalent.
21551
21552 @subsubheading Example
21553 N.A.
21554
21555
21556 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21557 @findex -target-select
21558
21559 @subsubheading Synopsis
21560
21561 @smallexample
21562 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21563 @end smallexample
21564
21565 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21566
21567 @table @samp
21568 @item @var{type}
21569 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21570 @item @var{parameters}
21571 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21572 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21573 @end table
21574
21575 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21576 which the target program is, in the following form:
21577
21578 @smallexample
21579 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21580 args=[@var{arg list}]
21581 @end smallexample
21582
21583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21584
21585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21586
21587 @subsubheading Example
21588
21589 @smallexample
21590 (gdb)
21591 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21592 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21593 (gdb)
21594 @end smallexample
21595
21596 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21597 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21598 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21599
21600
21601 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21602 @findex -target-file-put
21603
21604 @subsubheading Synopsis
21605
21606 @smallexample
21607 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21608 @end smallexample
21609
21610 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21611 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21612
21613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21614
21615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21616
21617 @subsubheading Example
21618
21619 @smallexample
21620 (gdb)
21621 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21622 ^done
21623 (gdb)
21624 @end smallexample
21625
21626
21627 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21628 @findex -target-file-get
21629
21630 @subsubheading Synopsis
21631
21632 @smallexample
21633 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21634 @end smallexample
21635
21636 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21637 on the host system.
21638
21639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21640
21641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21642
21643 @subsubheading Example
21644
21645 @smallexample
21646 (gdb)
21647 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21648 ^done
21649 (gdb)
21650 @end smallexample
21651
21652
21653 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21654 @findex -target-file-delete
21655
21656 @subsubheading Synopsis
21657
21658 @smallexample
21659 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21663
21664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21665
21666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21667
21668 @subsubheading Example
21669
21670 @smallexample
21671 (gdb)
21672 -target-file-delete remotefile
21673 ^done
21674 (gdb)
21675 @end smallexample
21676
21677
21678 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21679 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21680 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21681
21682 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21683
21684 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21685 @findex -gdb-exit
21686
21687 @subsubheading Synopsis
21688
21689 @smallexample
21690 -gdb-exit
21691 @end smallexample
21692
21693 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21694
21695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21696
21697 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21698
21699 @subsubheading Example
21700
21701 @smallexample
21702 (gdb)
21703 -gdb-exit
21704 ^exit
21705 @end smallexample
21706
21707
21708 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21709 @findex -exec-abort
21710
21711 @subsubheading Synopsis
21712
21713 @smallexample
21714 -exec-abort
21715 @end smallexample
21716
21717 Kill the inferior running program.
21718
21719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21720
21721 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21722
21723 @subsubheading Example
21724 N.A.
21725
21726
21727 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21728 @findex -gdb-set
21729
21730 @subsubheading Synopsis
21731
21732 @smallexample
21733 -gdb-set
21734 @end smallexample
21735
21736 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21737 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21738
21739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21740
21741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21742
21743 @subsubheading Example
21744
21745 @smallexample
21746 (gdb)
21747 -gdb-set $foo=3
21748 ^done
21749 (gdb)
21750 @end smallexample
21751
21752
21753 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21754 @findex -gdb-show
21755
21756 @subsubheading Synopsis
21757
21758 @smallexample
21759 -gdb-show
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21763
21764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21765
21766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21767
21768 @subsubheading Example
21769
21770 @smallexample
21771 (gdb)
21772 -gdb-show annotate
21773 ^done,value="0"
21774 (gdb)
21775 @end smallexample
21776
21777 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21778
21779
21780 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21781 @findex -gdb-version
21782
21783 @subsubheading Synopsis
21784
21785 @smallexample
21786 -gdb-version
21787 @end smallexample
21788
21789 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21790
21791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21792
21793 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21794 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21795
21796 @subsubheading Example
21797
21798 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21799 @c box in TeX.
21800 @smallexample
21801 (gdb)
21802 -gdb-version
21803 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21804 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21805 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21806 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21807 ~ certain conditions.
21808 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21809 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21810 ~ details.
21811 ~This GDB was configured as
21812 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21813 ^done
21814 (gdb)
21815 @end smallexample
21816
21817 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21818 @findex -list-features
21819
21820 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21821 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21822 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21823 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21824 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21825 startup.
21826
21827 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21828 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21829 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21830 is given below.
21831
21832 Example output:
21833
21834 @smallexample
21835 (gdb) -list-features
21836 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21837 @end smallexample
21838
21839 The current list of features is:
21840
21841 @itemize @minus
21842 @item
21843 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21844 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21845 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21846 @item
21847 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21848 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21849 @item
21850 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
21851
21852 @end itemize
21853
21854 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21855 @findex -interpreter-exec
21856
21857 @subheading Synopsis
21858
21859 @smallexample
21860 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21861 @end smallexample
21862 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21863
21864 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21865
21866 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21867
21868 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21869
21870 @subheading Example
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 (gdb)
21874 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21875 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21876 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21877 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21878 ^done
21879 (gdb)
21880 @end smallexample
21881
21882 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21883 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21884
21885 @subheading Synopsis
21886
21887 @smallexample
21888 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21889 @end smallexample
21890
21891 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21892
21893 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21894
21895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21896
21897 @subheading Example
21898
21899 @smallexample
21900 (gdb)
21901 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21902 ^done
21903 (gdb)
21904 @end smallexample
21905
21906 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21907 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21908
21909 @subheading Synopsis
21910
21911 @smallexample
21912 -inferior-tty-show
21913 @end smallexample
21914
21915 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21916
21917 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21918
21919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21920
21921 @subheading Example
21922
21923 @smallexample
21924 (gdb)
21925 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21926 ^done
21927 (gdb)
21928 -inferior-tty-show
21929 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21930 (gdb)
21931 @end smallexample
21932
21933 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21934 @findex -enable-timings
21935
21936 @subheading Synopsis
21937
21938 @smallexample
21939 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21940 @end smallexample
21941
21942 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21943 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21944 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21945 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21946
21947 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21948
21949 No equivalent.
21950
21951 @subheading Example
21952
21953 @smallexample
21954 (gdb)
21955 -enable-timings
21956 ^done
21957 (gdb)
21958 -break-insert main
21959 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21960 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21961 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21962 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21963 (gdb)
21964 -enable-timings no
21965 ^done
21966 (gdb)
21967 -exec-run
21968 ^running
21969 (gdb)
21970 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21971 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21972 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21973 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21974 (gdb)
21975 @end smallexample
21976
21977 @node Annotations
21978 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21979
21980 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21981 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21982 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21983 relatively high level.
21984
21985 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21986 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21987
21988 @ignore
21989 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21990 @end ignore
21991
21992 @menu
21993 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21994 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21995 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21996 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21997 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21998 * Annotations for Running::
21999 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22000 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22001 @end menu
22002
22003 @node Annotations Overview
22004 @section What is an Annotation?
22005 @cindex annotations
22006
22007 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22008 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22009 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22010 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22011 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22012 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22013 cannot contain newline characters.
22014
22015 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22016 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22017 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22018 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22019 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22020 means those three characters as output.
22021
22022 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22023 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22024 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22025 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22026 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22027 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22028 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22029 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22030 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22031
22032 @table @code
22033 @kindex set annotate
22034 @item set annotate @var{level}
22035 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22036 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22037
22038 @item show annotate
22039 @kindex show annotate
22040 Show the current annotation level.
22041 @end table
22042
22043 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22044
22045 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22046
22047 @smallexample
22048 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22049 GNU gdb 6.0
22050 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22051 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22052 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22053 under certain conditions.
22054 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22055 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22056 for details.
22057 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22058
22059 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22060 (@value{GDBP})
22061 ^Z^Zprompt
22062 @kbd{quit}
22063
22064 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22065 $
22066 @end smallexample
22067
22068 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22069 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22070 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22071 output from @value{GDBN}.
22072
22073 @node Server Prefix
22074 @section The Server Prefix
22075 @cindex server prefix
22076
22077 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22078 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22079 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22080 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22081 a transparent manner.
22082
22083 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22084 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22085 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22086
22087 @node Prompting
22088 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22089
22090 @cindex annotations for prompts
22091 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22092 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22093 over, etc.
22094
22095 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22096 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22097 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22098 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22099 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22100 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22101 features the following annotations:
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22105 ^Z^Zprompt
22106 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22107 @end smallexample
22108
22109 The input types are
22110
22111 @table @code
22112 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22113 @findex prompt annotation
22114 @findex post-prompt annotation
22115 @item prompt
22116 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22117
22118 @findex pre-commands annotation
22119 @findex commands annotation
22120 @findex post-commands annotation
22121 @item commands
22122 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22123 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22124
22125 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22126 @findex overload-choice annotation
22127 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22128 @item overload-choice
22129 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22130
22131 @findex pre-query annotation
22132 @findex query annotation
22133 @findex post-query annotation
22134 @item query
22135 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22136
22137 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22138 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22139 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22140 @item prompt-for-continue
22141 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22142 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22143 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22144 presence of annotations.
22145 @end table
22146
22147 @node Errors
22148 @section Errors
22149 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22150
22151 @findex quit annotation
22152 @smallexample
22153 ^Z^Zquit
22154 @end smallexample
22155
22156 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22157
22158 @findex error annotation
22159 @smallexample
22160 ^Z^Zerror
22161 @end smallexample
22162
22163 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22164
22165 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22166 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22167 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22168 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22169 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22170 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22171 to the top level.
22172
22173 @findex error-begin annotation
22174 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22175
22176 @smallexample
22177 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22178 @end smallexample
22179
22180 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22181 message.
22182
22183 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22184 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22185 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22186
22187 @node Invalidation
22188 @section Invalidation Notices
22189
22190 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22191 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22192 changed.
22193
22194 @table @code
22195 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22196 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22197
22198 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22199 have changed.
22200
22201 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22202 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22203
22204 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22205 deleted a breakpoint.
22206 @end table
22207
22208 @node Annotations for Running
22209 @section Running the Program
22210 @cindex annotations for running programs
22211
22212 @findex starting annotation
22213 @findex stopping annotation
22214 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22215 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22216
22217 @smallexample
22218 ^Z^Zstarting
22219 @end smallexample
22220
22221 is output. When the program stops,
22222
22223 @smallexample
22224 ^Z^Zstopped
22225 @end smallexample
22226
22227 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22228 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22229
22230 @table @code
22231 @findex exited annotation
22232 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22233 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22234 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22235
22236 @findex signalled annotation
22237 @findex signal-name annotation
22238 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22239 @findex signal-string annotation
22240 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22241 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22242 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22243 annotation continues:
22244
22245 @smallexample
22246 @var{intro-text}
22247 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22248 @var{name}
22249 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22250 @var{middle-text}
22251 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22252 @var{string}
22253 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22254 @var{end-text}
22255 @end smallexample
22256
22257 @noindent
22258 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22259 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22260 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22261 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22262 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22263
22264 @findex signal annotation
22265 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22266 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22267 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22268 terminated with it.
22269
22270 @findex breakpoint annotation
22271 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22272 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22273
22274 @findex watchpoint annotation
22275 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22276 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22277 @end table
22278
22279 @node Source Annotations
22280 @section Displaying Source
22281 @cindex annotations for source display
22282
22283 @findex source annotation
22284 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22285
22286 @smallexample
22287 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22288 @end smallexample
22289
22290 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22291 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22292 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22293 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22294 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22295 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22296 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22297 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22298 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22299 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22300 depend on the language).
22301
22302 @node GDB Bugs
22303 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22304 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22305 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22306
22307 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22308
22309 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22310 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22311 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22312 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22313
22314 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22315 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22316
22317 @menu
22318 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22319 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22320 @end menu
22321
22322 @node Bug Criteria
22323 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22324 @cindex bug criteria
22325
22326 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22327
22328 @itemize @bullet
22329 @cindex fatal signal
22330 @cindex debugger crash
22331 @cindex crash of debugger
22332 @item
22333 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22334 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22335
22336 @cindex error on valid input
22337 @item
22338 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22339 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22340 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22341
22342 @cindex invalid input
22343 @item
22344 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22345 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22346 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22347 for traditional practice''.
22348
22349 @item
22350 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22351 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22352 @end itemize
22353
22354 @node Bug Reporting
22355 @section How to Report Bugs
22356 @cindex bug reports
22357 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22358
22359 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22360 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22361 contact that organization first.
22362
22363 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22364 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22365 distribution.
22366 @c should add a web page ref...
22367
22368 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22369 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22370 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22371 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22372 be used.
22373
22374 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22375 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22376 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22377 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22378
22379 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22380 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22381 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22382 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22383 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22384 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22385 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22386 bug reports to the mailing list.
22387
22388 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22389 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22390 fact or leave it out, state it!
22391
22392 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22393 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22394 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22395 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22396 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22397 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22398 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22399 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22400 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22401
22402 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22403 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22404 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22405 self-contained.
22406
22407 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22408 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22409 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22410 bugs properly.
22411
22412 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22413
22414 @itemize @bullet
22415 @item
22416 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22417 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22418 version}.
22419
22420 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22421 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22422
22423 @item
22424 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22425 version number.
22426
22427 @item
22428 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22429 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22430
22431 @item
22432 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22433 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22434 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22435 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22436 those compilers.
22437
22438 @item
22439 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22440 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22441 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22442 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22443
22444 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22445 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22446
22447 @item
22448 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22449 reproduce the bug.
22450
22451 @item
22452 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22453 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22454
22455 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22456 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22457 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22458 a chance to make a mistake.
22459
22460 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22461 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22462 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22463 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22464 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22465 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22466 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22467 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22468
22469 @pindex script
22470 @cindex recording a session script
22471 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22472 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22473 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22474 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22475
22476 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22477 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22478
22479 @item
22480 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22481 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22482 it by context, not by line number.
22483
22484 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22485 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22486
22487 @end itemize
22488
22489 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22490
22491 @itemize @bullet
22492 @item
22493 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22494
22495 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22496 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22497 changes will not affect it.
22498
22499 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22500 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22501 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22502 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22503
22504 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22505 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22506 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22507 less time, and so on.
22508
22509 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22510 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22511
22512 @item
22513 A patch for the bug.
22514
22515 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22516 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22517 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22518 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22519
22520 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22521 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22522 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22523 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22524
22525 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22526 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22527 help us to understand.
22528
22529 @item
22530 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22531
22532 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22533 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22534 @end itemize
22535
22536 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22537 @c and consists of the two following files:
22538 @c rluser.texinfo
22539 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22540 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22541 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22542 @include rluser.texi
22543 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22544
22545
22546 @node Formatting Documentation
22547 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22548
22549 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22550 @cindex reference card
22551 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22552 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22553 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22554 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22555 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22556 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22557
22558 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22559 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22560
22561 @smallexample
22562 make refcard.dvi
22563 @end smallexample
22564
22565 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22566 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22567 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22568 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22569 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22570
22571 @cindex documentation
22572
22573 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22574 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22575 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22576 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22577 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22578 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22579
22580 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22581 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22582 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22583 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22584 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22585 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22586 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22587 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22588
22589 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22590 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22591 @code{makeinfo}.
22592
22593 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22594 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22595 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22596
22597 @smallexample
22598 cd gdb
22599 make gdb.info
22600 @end smallexample
22601
22602 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22603 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22604 Texinfo definitions file.
22605
22606 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22607 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22608 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22609 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22610 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22611 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22612 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22613
22614 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22615 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22616 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22617 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22618 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22619 directory.
22620
22621 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22622 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22623 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22624 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22625
22626 @smallexample
22627 make gdb.dvi
22628 @end smallexample
22629
22630 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22631
22632 @node Installing GDB
22633 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22634 @cindex installation
22635
22636 @menu
22637 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22638 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22639 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22640 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22641 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22642 @end menu
22643
22644 @node Requirements
22645 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22646 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22647
22648 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22649 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22650
22651 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22652 @table @asis
22653 @item ISO C90 compiler
22654 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22655 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22656
22657 @end table
22658
22659 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22660 @table @asis
22661 @item Expat
22662 @anchor{Expat}
22663 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22664 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22665 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22666 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22667 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22668 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22669
22670 Expat is used for:
22671
22672 @itemize @bullet
22673 @item
22674 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22675 @item
22676 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22677 @item
22678 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22679 @item
22680 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22681 @end itemize
22682
22683 @end table
22684
22685 @node Running Configure
22686 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22687 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22688 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22689 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22690 build the @code{gdb} program.
22691 @iftex
22692 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22693 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22694 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22695 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22696 @end iftex
22697
22698 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22699 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22700 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22701
22702 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22703 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22704
22705 @table @code
22706 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22707 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22708
22709 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22710 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22711
22712 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22713 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22714
22715 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22716 @sc{gnu} include files
22717
22718 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22719 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22720
22721 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22722 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22723
22724 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22725 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22726
22727 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22728 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22729
22730 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22731 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22732 @end table
22733
22734 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22735 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22736 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22737
22738 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22739 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22740 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22741 argument.
22742
22743 For example:
22744
22745 @smallexample
22746 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22747 ./configure @var{host}
22748 make
22749 @end smallexample
22750
22751 @noindent
22752 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22753 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22754 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22755 correct value by examining your system.)
22756
22757 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22758 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22759 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22760 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22761
22762 @need 750
22763 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22764 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22765 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22766
22767 @smallexample
22768 sh configure @var{host}
22769 @end smallexample
22770
22771 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22772 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22773 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22774 @file{configure}
22775 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22776 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22777
22778 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22779 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22780 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22781 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22782 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22783 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22784 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22785 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22786 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22787
22788 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22789 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22790 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22791 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22792 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22793
22794 @node Separate Objdir
22795 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22796
22797 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22798 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22799 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22800 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22801 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22802 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22803 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22804 program specified there.
22805
22806 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22807 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22808 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22809 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22810 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22811 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22812
22813 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22814 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22815
22816 @smallexample
22817 @group
22818 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22819 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22820 cd ../gdb-sun4
22821 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22822 make
22823 @end group
22824 @end smallexample
22825
22826 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22827 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22828 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22829 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22830 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22831 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22832
22833 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22834 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22835 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22836 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22837 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22838
22839 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22840 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22841 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22842 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22843 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22844 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22845
22846 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22847 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22848 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22849
22850 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22851 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22852 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22853 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22854 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22855
22856 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22857 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22858 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22859 with each other.
22860
22861 @node Config Names
22862 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22863
22864 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22865 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22866 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22867 of information in the following pattern:
22868
22869 @smallexample
22870 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22871 @end smallexample
22872
22873 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22874 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22875 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22876
22877 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22878 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22879 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22880 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22881 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22882 abbreviations---for example:
22883
22884 @smallexample
22885 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22886 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22887 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22888 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22889 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22890 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22891 % sh config.sub sun4
22892 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22893 % sh config.sub sun3
22894 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22895 % sh config.sub i986v
22896 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22897 @end smallexample
22898
22899 @noindent
22900 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22901 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22902
22903 @node Configure Options
22904 @section @file{configure} Options
22905
22906 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22907 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22908 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22909 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22910
22911 @smallexample
22912 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22913 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22914 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22915 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22916 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22917 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22918 @var{host}
22919 @end smallexample
22920
22921 @noindent
22922 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22923 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22924 @samp{--}.
22925
22926 @table @code
22927 @item --help
22928 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22929
22930 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22931 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22932 @file{@var{dir}}.
22933
22934 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22935 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22936 @file{@var{dir}}.
22937
22938 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22939 @need 2000
22940 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22941 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22942 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22943 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22944 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22945 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22946 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22947 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22948 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22949 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22950 @var{dirname}.
22951
22952 @item --norecursion
22953 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22954 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22955
22956 @item --target=@var{target}
22957 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22958 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22959 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22960
22961 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22962
22963 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22964 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22965
22966 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22967 @end table
22968
22969 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22970 needed for special purposes only.
22971
22972 @node Maintenance Commands
22973 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22974 @cindex maintenance commands
22975 @cindex internal commands
22976
22977 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22978 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22979 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22980 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22981 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22982
22983 @table @code
22984 @kindex maint agent
22985 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22986 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22987 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22988 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22989
22990 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22991 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22992 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22993 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22994 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22995 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22996 is shown:
22997
22998 @table @code
22999 @item breakpoint
23000 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23001
23002 @item watchpoint
23003 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23004
23005 @item longjmp
23006 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23007 @code{longjmp} calls.
23008
23009 @item longjmp resume
23010 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23011
23012 @item until
23013 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23014
23015 @item finish
23016 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23017
23018 @item shlib events
23019 Shared library events.
23020
23021 @end table
23022
23023 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23024 @item maint check-symtabs
23025 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23026
23027 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23028 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23029 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23030
23031 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23032 @item maint cplus namespace
23033 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23034
23035 @kindex maint demangle
23036 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23037 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23038
23039 @kindex maint deprecate
23040 @kindex maint undeprecate
23041 @cindex deprecated commands
23042 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23043 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23044 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23045 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23046 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23047 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23048 the replacement as part of the warning.
23049
23050 @kindex maint dump-me
23051 @item maint dump-me
23052 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23053 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23054 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23055 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23056
23057 @kindex maint internal-error
23058 @kindex maint internal-warning
23059 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23060 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23061 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23062 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23063 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23064 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23065 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23066 @value{GDBN} session.
23067
23068 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23069 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23070
23071 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23072
23073 @smallexample
23074 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23075 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23076 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23077 debugging may prove unreliable.
23078 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23079 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23080 (@value{GDBP})
23081 @end smallexample
23082
23083 @kindex maint packet
23084 @item maint packet @var{text}
23085 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23086 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23087 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23088 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23089 checksum.
23090
23091 @kindex maint print architecture
23092 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23093 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23094 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23095
23096 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23097 @item maint print c-tdesc
23098 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23099 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23100 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23101
23102 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23103 @item maint print dummy-frames
23104 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23105
23106 @smallexample
23107 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23108 @dots{}
23109 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23110 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23111 58 return (a + b);
23112 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23113 @dots{}
23114 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23115 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23116 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23117 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23118 (@value{GDBP})
23119 @end smallexample
23120
23121 Takes an optional file parameter.
23122
23123 @kindex maint print registers
23124 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23125 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23126 @kindex maint print register-groups
23127 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23128 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23129 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23130 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23131 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23132
23133 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23134 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23135 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23136 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23137 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23138 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23139
23140 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23141 write the information.
23142
23143 @kindex maint print reggroups
23144 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23145 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23146 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23147 information.
23148
23149 The register groups info looks like this:
23150
23151 @smallexample
23152 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23153 Group Type
23154 general user
23155 float user
23156 all user
23157 vector user
23158 system user
23159 save internal
23160 restore internal
23161 @end smallexample
23162
23163 @kindex flushregs
23164 @item flushregs
23165 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23166
23167 @kindex maint print objfiles
23168 @cindex info for known object files
23169 @item maint print objfiles
23170 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23171 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23172 and symtabs.
23173
23174 @kindex maint print statistics
23175 @cindex bcache statistics
23176 @item maint print statistics
23177 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23178 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23179 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23180 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23181 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23182 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23183 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23184 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23185 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23186 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23187 lengths.
23188
23189 @kindex maint print target-stack
23190 @cindex target stack description
23191 @item maint print target-stack
23192 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23193 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23194 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23195 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23196 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23197 address.
23198
23199 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23200 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23201
23202 @kindex maint print type
23203 @cindex type chain of a data type
23204 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23205 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23206 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23207 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23208 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23209 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23210
23211 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23212 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23213 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23214 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23215 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23216
23217 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23218 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23219 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23220 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23221 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23222 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23223 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23224 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23225 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23226
23227 @kindex maint set profile
23228 @kindex maint show profile
23229 @cindex profiling GDB
23230 @item maint set profile
23231 @itemx maint show profile
23232 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23233
23234 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23235 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23236 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23237 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23238 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23239 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23240 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23241
23242 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23243 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23244
23245 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23246 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23247 @item maint show-debug-regs
23248 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23249 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23250 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23251 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23252 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23253
23254 @kindex maint space
23255 @cindex memory used by commands
23256 @item maint space
23257 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23258 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23259 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23260 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23261 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23262
23263 @kindex maint time
23264 @cindex time of command execution
23265 @item maint time
23266 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23267 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23268 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23269 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23270 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23271
23272 @kindex maint translate-address
23273 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23274 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23275 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23276 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23277 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23278 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23279 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23280
23281 @end table
23282
23283 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23284 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23285
23286 @table @code
23287 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23288 @kindex set watchdog
23289 @cindex watchdog timer
23290 @cindex timeout for commands
23291 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23292 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23293 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23294
23295 @item show watchdog
23296 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23297 @end table
23298
23299 @node Remote Protocol
23300 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23301
23302 @menu
23303 * Overview::
23304 * Packets::
23305 * Stop Reply Packets::
23306 * General Query Packets::
23307 * Register Packet Format::
23308 * Tracepoint Packets::
23309 * Host I/O Packets::
23310 * Interrupts::
23311 * Examples::
23312 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23313 * Library List Format::
23314 * Memory Map Format::
23315 @end menu
23316
23317 @node Overview
23318 @section Overview
23319
23320 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23321 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23322 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23323 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23324
23325 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23326 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23327
23328 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23329 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23330 @cindex remote serial protocol
23331 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23332 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23333 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23334 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23335
23336 @smallexample
23337 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23338 @end smallexample
23339 @noindent
23340
23341 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23342 @noindent
23343 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23344 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23345 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23346
23347 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23348 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23349
23350 @smallexample
23351 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23352 @end smallexample
23353
23354 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23355 @noindent
23356 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23357 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23358 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23359
23360 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23361 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23362 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23363 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23364 retransmission):
23365
23366 @smallexample
23367 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23368 <- @code{+}
23369 @end smallexample
23370 @noindent
23371
23372 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23373 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23374 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23375 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23376
23377 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23378 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23379 exceptions).
23380
23381 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23382 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23383 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23384 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23385
23386 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23387 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23388 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23389
23390 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23391 @anchor{Binary Data}
23392 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23393 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23394 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23395 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23396 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23397 binary data.
23398
23399 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23400 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23401 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23402 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23403 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23404 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23405 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23406 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23407 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23408 (described next).
23409
23410 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23411 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23412 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23413 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23414 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23415 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23416 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23417 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23418 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23419 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23420 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23421 3}} more times.
23422
23423 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23424 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23425 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23426 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23427 @samp{0*"00}.
23428
23429 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23430 error number. That number is not well defined.
23431
23432 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23433 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23434 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23435 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23436 on that response.
23437
23438 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23439 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23440 optional.
23441
23442 @node Packets
23443 @section Packets
23444
23445 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23446 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23447 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23448 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23449
23450 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23451 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23452 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23453 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23454 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23455 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23456 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23457 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23458 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23459 @var{baz}.
23460
23461 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23462 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23463
23464 Here are the packet descriptions.
23465
23466 @table @samp
23467
23468 @item !
23469 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23470 @anchor{extended mode}
23471 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23472 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23473 debugged.
23474
23475 Reply:
23476 @table @samp
23477 @item OK
23478 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23479 @end table
23480
23481 @item ?
23482 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23483 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23484 step and continue.
23485
23486 Reply:
23487 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23488
23489 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23490 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23491 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23492 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23493 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23494
23495 Reply:
23496 @table @samp
23497 @item OK
23498 The arguments were set.
23499 @item E @var{NN}
23500 An error occurred.
23501 @end table
23502
23503 @item b @var{baud}
23504 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23505 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23506 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23507
23508 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23509 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23510 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23511
23512 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23513 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23514 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23515 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23516 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23517
23518 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23519 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23520 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23521 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23522
23523 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23524 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23525
23526 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23527 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23528 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23529 resume at current address.
23530
23531 Reply:
23532 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23533
23534 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23535 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23536 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23537 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23538
23539 Reply:
23540 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23541
23542 @item d
23543 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23544 Toggle debug flag.
23545
23546 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23547 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23548
23549 @item D
23550 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23551 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23552 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23553
23554 Reply:
23555 @table @samp
23556 @item OK
23557 for success
23558 @item E @var{NN}
23559 for an error
23560 @end table
23561
23562 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23563 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23564 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23565 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23566 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23567
23568 @item g
23569 @anchor{read registers packet}
23570 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23571 Read general registers.
23572
23573 Reply:
23574 @table @samp
23575 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23576 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23577 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23578 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23579 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23580 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23581 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23582 @item E @var{NN}
23583 for an error.
23584 @end table
23585
23586 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23587 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23588 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23589 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23590
23591 Reply:
23592 @table @samp
23593 @item OK
23594 for success
23595 @item E @var{NN}
23596 for an error
23597 @end table
23598
23599 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23600 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23601 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23602 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23603 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23604 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23605 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23606
23607 Reply:
23608 @table @samp
23609 @item OK
23610 for success
23611 @item E @var{NN}
23612 for an error
23613 @end table
23614
23615 @c FIXME: JTC:
23616 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23617 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23618 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23619 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23620 @c described. For example:
23621 @c
23622 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23623 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23624 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23625 @c
23626 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23627 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23628 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23629
23630 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23631 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23632 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23633 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23634 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23635 step starting at that address.
23636
23637 @item I
23638 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23639 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23640 step packet}.
23641
23642 @item k
23643 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23644 Kill request.
23645
23646 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23647 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23648 thread?)}.
23649
23650 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23651 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23652 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23653 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23654
23655 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23656 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23657 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23658 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23659 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23660 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23661 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23662 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23663
23664 Reply:
23665 @table @samp
23666 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23667 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23668 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23669 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23670 @item E @var{NN}
23671 @var{NN} is errno
23672 @end table
23673
23674 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23675 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23676 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23677 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23678 hexadecimal number.
23679
23680 Reply:
23681 @table @samp
23682 @item OK
23683 for success
23684 @item E @var{NN}
23685 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23686 written).
23687 @end table
23688
23689 @item p @var{n}
23690 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23691 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23692 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23693 register value is encoded.
23694
23695 Reply:
23696 @table @samp
23697 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23698 the register's value
23699 @item E @var{NN}
23700 for an error
23701 @item
23702 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23703 @end table
23704
23705 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23706 @anchor{write register packet}
23707 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23708 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23709 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23710 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23711
23712 Reply:
23713 @table @samp
23714 @item OK
23715 for success
23716 @item E @var{NN}
23717 for an error
23718 @end table
23719
23720 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23721 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23722 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23723 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23724 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23725 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23726
23727 @item r
23728 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23729 Reset the entire system.
23730
23731 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23732
23733 @item R @var{XX}
23734 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23735 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23736 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23737
23738 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23739
23740 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23741 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23742 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23743 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23744
23745 Reply:
23746 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23747
23748 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23749 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23750 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23751 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23752 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23753
23754 Reply:
23755 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23756
23757 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23758 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23759 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23760 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23761 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23762
23763 @item T @var{XX}
23764 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23765 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23766
23767 Reply:
23768 @table @samp
23769 @item OK
23770 thread is still alive
23771 @item E @var{NN}
23772 thread is dead
23773 @end table
23774
23775 @item v
23776 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23777 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23778
23779 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
23780 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
23781 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
23782 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. If the stub is currently
23783 controlling a process, it is killed. The attached process is stopped.
23784
23785 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23786
23787 Reply:
23788 @table @samp
23789 @item E @var{nn}
23790 for an error
23791 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23792 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23793 @end table
23794
23795 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23796 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23797 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23798 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23799 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23800 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23801 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23802 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23803
23804 @table @samp
23805 @item c
23806 Continue.
23807 @item C @var{sig}
23808 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23809 @item s
23810 Step.
23811 @item S @var{sig}
23812 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23813 @end table
23814
23815 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23816 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23817
23818 Reply:
23819 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23820
23821 @item vCont?
23822 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23823 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23824
23825 Reply:
23826 @table @samp
23827 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23828 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23829 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23830 @item
23831 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23832 @end table
23833
23834 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23835 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23836 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23837 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23838
23839 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23840 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23841 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23842 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23843 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23844 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23845 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23846 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23847 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23848 packet is received.
23849
23850 Reply:
23851 @table @samp
23852 @item OK
23853 for success
23854 @item E @var{NN}
23855 for an error
23856 @end table
23857
23858 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23859 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23860 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23861 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23862 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23863 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23864 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23865 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23866 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23867 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23868 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23869 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23870
23871
23872 Reply:
23873 @table @samp
23874 @item OK
23875 for success
23876 @item E.memtype
23877 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23878 @item E @var{NN}
23879 for an error
23880 @end table
23881
23882 @item vFlashDone
23883 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23884 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23885 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23886 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23887 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23888 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23889 request is completed.
23890
23891 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
23892 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
23893 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
23894 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
23895 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
23896 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
23897 state. If the stub is currently controlling a process, it is killed.
23898
23899 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23900
23901 Reply:
23902 @table @samp
23903 @item E @var{nn}
23904 for an error
23905 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23906 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23907 @end table
23908
23909 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23910 @anchor{X packet}
23911 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23912 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23913 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23914 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23915
23916 Reply:
23917 @table @samp
23918 @item OK
23919 for success
23920 @item E @var{NN}
23921 for an error
23922 @end table
23923
23924 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23925 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23926 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23927 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23928 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23929 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23930 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23931 @var{length} bytes.
23932
23933 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23934 separately.
23935
23936 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23937 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23938 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23939 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23940 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23941 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23942
23943 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23944 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23945 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23946 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23947 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23948 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23949
23950 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23951 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23952 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23953 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23954 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23955
23956 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23957 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23958 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23959 target, is not defined.}
23960
23961 Reply:
23962 @table @samp
23963 @item OK
23964 success
23965 @item
23966 not supported
23967 @item E @var{NN}
23968 for an error
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23972 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23973 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23974 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23975 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23976 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23977
23978 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23979 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23980
23981 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23982 movement.}
23983
23984 Reply:
23985 @table @samp
23986 @item OK
23987 success
23988 @item
23989 not supported
23990 @item E @var{NN}
23991 for an error
23992 @end table
23993
23994 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23995 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23996 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23997 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23998 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23999
24000 Reply:
24001 @table @samp
24002 @item OK
24003 success
24004 @item
24005 not supported
24006 @item E @var{NN}
24007 for an error
24008 @end table
24009
24010 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24011 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24012 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24013 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24014 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24015
24016 Reply:
24017 @table @samp
24018 @item OK
24019 success
24020 @item
24021 not supported
24022 @item E @var{NN}
24023 for an error
24024 @end table
24025
24026 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24027 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24028 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24029 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24030 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24031
24032 Reply:
24033 @table @samp
24034 @item OK
24035 success
24036 @item
24037 not supported
24038 @item E @var{NN}
24039 for an error
24040 @end table
24041
24042 @end table
24043
24044 @node Stop Reply Packets
24045 @section Stop Reply Packets
24046 @cindex stop reply packets
24047
24048 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24049 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24050 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24051 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24052 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24053 @value{GDBN} source code.
24054
24055 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24056 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24057 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24058 components.
24059
24060 @table @samp
24061
24062 @item S @var{AA}
24063 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24064 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24065 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24066
24067 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24068 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24069 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24070 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24071 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24072 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24073 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24074 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24075
24076 @itemize @bullet
24077 @item
24078 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24079 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24080 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24081 two-digit hex number.
24082
24083 @item
24084 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24085 hex.
24086
24087 @item
24088 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24089 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24090 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24091 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24092
24093 @item
24094 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24095 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24096 future.
24097 @end itemize
24098
24099 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24100
24101 @table @samp
24102 @item watch
24103 @itemx rwatch
24104 @itemx awatch
24105 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24106 hex.
24107
24108 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24109 @item library
24110 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24111 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24112 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24113 @end table
24114
24115 @item W @var{AA}
24116 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24117 applicable to certain targets.
24118
24119 @item X @var{AA}
24120 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24121
24122 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24123 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24124 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24125 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24126 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24127
24128 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24129 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24130 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24131 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24132 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24133 system calls.
24134
24135 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24136 this very system call.
24137
24138 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24139 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24140 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24141 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24142 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24143 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24144
24145 @end table
24146
24147 @node General Query Packets
24148 @section General Query Packets
24149 @cindex remote query requests
24150
24151 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24152 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24153 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24154 sending information to and from the stub.
24155
24156 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24157 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24158 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24159 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24160 conventions:
24161
24162 @itemize @bullet
24163 @item
24164 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24165 @item
24166 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24167 letter.
24168 @item
24169 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24170 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24171 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24172 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24173 @end itemize
24174
24175 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24176 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24177 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24178 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24179 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24180 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24181 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24182 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24183 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24184 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24185 packet.}.
24186
24187 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24188 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24189 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24190 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24191 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24192
24193 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24194
24195 @table @samp
24196
24197 @item qC
24198 @cindex current thread, remote request
24199 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24200 Return the current thread id.
24201
24202 Reply:
24203 @table @samp
24204 @item QC @var{pid}
24205 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24206 @item @r{(anything else)}
24207 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24208 @end table
24209
24210 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24211 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24212 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24213 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24214 Reply:
24215 @table @samp
24216 @item E @var{NN}
24217 An error (such as memory fault)
24218 @item C @var{crc32}
24219 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24220 @end table
24221
24222 @item qfThreadInfo
24223 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24224 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24225 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24226 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24227 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24228 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24229 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24230 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24231 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24232 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24233
24234 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24235
24236 Reply:
24237 @table @samp
24238 @item m @var{id}
24239 A single thread id
24240 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24241 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24242 @item l
24243 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24244 @end table
24245
24246 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24247 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24248 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24249 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24250 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24251
24252 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24253 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24254 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24255 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24256 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24257
24258 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24259 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24260
24261 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24262 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24263 information associated with the variable.)
24264
24265 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24266 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24267 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24268 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24269 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24270 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24271
24272 Reply:
24273 @table @samp
24274 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24275 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24276 local storage requested.
24277
24278 @item E @var{nn}
24279 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24280
24281 @item
24282 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24283 @end table
24284
24285 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24286 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24287 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24288 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24289 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24290 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24291 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24292
24293 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24294
24295 Reply:
24296 @table @samp
24297 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24298 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24299 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24300 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24301 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24302 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24303 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24304 @end table
24305
24306 @item qOffsets
24307 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24308 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24309 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24310 image.
24311
24312 Reply:
24313 @table @samp
24314 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24315 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24316 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24317 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24318 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24319 segments by the supplied offsets.
24320
24321 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24322 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24323 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24324
24325 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24326 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24327 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24328 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24329 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24330 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24331 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24332 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24333 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24334 @end table
24335
24336 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24337 @cindex thread information, remote request
24338 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24339 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24340 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24341
24342 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24343 (see below).
24344
24345 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24346
24347 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24348 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24349 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24350 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24351 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24352 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24353 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24354 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24355 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24356 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24357 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24358 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24359 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24360
24361 Reply:
24362 @table @samp
24363 @item OK
24364 The request succeeded.
24365
24366 @item E @var{nn}
24367 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24368
24369 @item
24370 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24371 the stub.
24372 @end table
24373
24374 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24375 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24378
24379 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24380 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24381 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24382 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24383 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24384 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24385 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24386 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24387 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24388
24389 Reply:
24390 @table @samp
24391 @item OK
24392 A command response with no output.
24393 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24394 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24395 @item E @var{NN}
24396 Indicate a badly formed request.
24397 @item
24398 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24399 @end table
24400
24401 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24402 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24403 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24404 packets.)
24405
24406 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24407 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24408 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24409 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24410 @anchor{qSupported}
24411 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24412 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24413 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24414 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24415 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24416 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24417 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24418 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24419 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24420 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24421 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24422 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24423 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24424 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24425
24426 Reply:
24427 @table @samp
24428 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24429 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24430 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24431 possible forms).
24432 @item
24433 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24434 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24435 @end table
24436
24437 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24438 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24439 are:
24440
24441 @table @samp
24442 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24443 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24444 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24445 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24446 @item @var{name}+
24447 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24448 need an associated value.
24449 @item @var{name}-
24450 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24451 @item @var{name}?
24452 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24453 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24454 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24455 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24456 @end table
24457
24458 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24459 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24460 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24461 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24462 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24463
24464 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24465 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24466 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24467 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24468 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24469 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24470 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24471 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24472 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24473 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24474 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24475 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24476 all the features it supports.
24477
24478 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24479 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24480
24481 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24482 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24483 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24484 form response.
24485
24486 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24487 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24488 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24489 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24490
24491 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24492 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24493 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24494 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24495 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24496
24497 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24498
24499 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24500 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24501 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24502 @item Feature Name
24503 @tab Value Required
24504 @tab Default
24505 @tab Probe Allowed
24506
24507 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24508 @tab Yes
24509 @tab @samp{-}
24510 @tab No
24511
24512 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24513 @tab No
24514 @tab @samp{-}
24515 @tab Yes
24516
24517 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24518 @tab No
24519 @tab @samp{-}
24520 @tab Yes
24521
24522 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24523 @tab No
24524 @tab @samp{-}
24525 @tab Yes
24526
24527 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24528 @tab No
24529 @tab @samp{-}
24530 @tab Yes
24531
24532 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24533 @tab No
24534 @tab @samp{-}
24535 @tab Yes
24536
24537 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24538 @tab No
24539 @tab @samp{-}
24540 @tab Yes
24541
24542 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24543 @tab No
24544 @tab @samp{-}
24545 @tab Yes
24546
24547 @end multitable
24548
24549 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24550
24551 @table @samp
24552 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24553 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24554 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24555 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24556 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24557 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24558 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24559 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24560 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24561 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24562
24563 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24564 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24565 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24566
24567 @item qXfer:features:read
24568 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24569 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24570
24571 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24572 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24573 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24574
24575 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24576 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24577 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24578
24579 @item qXfer:spu:read
24580 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24581 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24582
24583 @item qXfer:spu:write
24584 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24585 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24586
24587 @item QPassSignals
24588 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24589 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24590
24591 @end table
24592
24593 @item qSymbol::
24594 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24595 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24596 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24597 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24598
24599 Reply:
24600 @table @samp
24601 @item OK
24602 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24603 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24604 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24605 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24606 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24607 below.
24608 @end table
24609
24610 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24611 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24612
24613 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24614 target has previously requested.
24615
24616 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24617 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24618 will be empty.
24619
24620 Reply:
24621 @table @samp
24622 @item OK
24623 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24624 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24625 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24626 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24627 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24628 @end table
24629
24630 @item QTDP
24631 @itemx QTFrame
24632 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24633
24634 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24635 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24636 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24637 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24638 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24639 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24640 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24641 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24642 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24643 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24644
24645 Reply:
24646 @table @samp
24647 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24648 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24649 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24650 the thread's attributes.
24651 @end table
24652
24653 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24654 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24655 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24656 packets.)
24657
24658 @item QTStart
24659 @itemx QTStop
24660 @itemx QTinit
24661 @itemx QTro
24662 @itemx qTStatus
24663 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24664
24665 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24666 @cindex read special object, remote request
24667 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24668 @anchor{qXfer read}
24669 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24670 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24671 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24672 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24673 additional details about what data to access.
24674
24675 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24676 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24677 formats, listed below.
24678
24679 @table @samp
24680 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24681 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24682 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24683 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24684
24685 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24686 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24687
24688 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24689 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24690 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24691 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24692 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24693
24694 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24695 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24696
24697 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24698 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24699 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24700 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24701 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24702
24703 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24704 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24705 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24706
24707 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24708 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24709
24710 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24711 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24712 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24713 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24714 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24715
24716 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24717 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24718
24719 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24720 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24721 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24722 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24723 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24724 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24725 in that context to be accessed.
24726
24727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24729 @end table
24730
24731 Reply:
24732 @table @samp
24733 @item m @var{data}
24734 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24735 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24736 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24737 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24738 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24739 request.
24740
24741 @item l @var{data}
24742 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24743 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24744 than the @var{length} in the request.
24745
24746 @item l
24747 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24748 There is no more data to be read.
24749
24750 @item E00
24751 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24752
24753 @item E @var{nn}
24754 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24755 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24756
24757 @item
24758 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24759 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24760 @end table
24761
24762 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24763 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24764 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24765 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24766 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24767 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24768 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24769 to access.
24770
24771 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24772 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24773 formats, listed below.
24774
24775 @table @samp
24776 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24777 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24778 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24779 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24780 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24781 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24782 in that context to be accessed.
24783
24784 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24785 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24786 @end table
24787
24788 Reply:
24789 @table @samp
24790 @item @var{nn}
24791 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24792 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24793
24794 @item E00
24795 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24796
24797 @item E @var{nn}
24798 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24799 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24800
24801 @item
24802 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24803 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24804 @end table
24805
24806 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24807 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24808 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24809 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24810 must respond with an empty packet.
24811
24812 @end table
24813
24814 @node Register Packet Format
24815 @section Register Packet Format
24816
24817 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24818 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24819 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24820 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24821 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24822 most-significant - least-significant.
24823
24824 @table @r
24825
24826 @item MIPS32
24827
24828 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24829 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24830 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24831
24832 @item MIPS64
24833
24834 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24835 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24836 as @code{MIPS32}.
24837
24838 @end table
24839
24840 @node Tracepoint Packets
24841 @section Tracepoint Packets
24842 @cindex tracepoint packets
24843 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24844
24845 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24846 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24847
24848 @table @samp
24849
24850 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24851 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24852 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24853 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24854 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24855 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24856 tracepoint's actions.
24857
24858 Replies:
24859 @table @samp
24860 @item OK
24861 The packet was understood and carried out.
24862 @item
24863 The packet was not recognized.
24864 @end table
24865
24866 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24867 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24868 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24869 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24870 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24871 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24872 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24873
24874 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24875 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24876 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24877 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24878 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24879 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24880 tracepoint actions.
24881
24882 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24883 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24884 following forms:
24885
24886 @table @samp
24887
24888 @item R @var{mask}
24889 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24890 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24891 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24892 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24893 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24894
24895 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24896 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24897 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24898 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24899 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24900 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24901 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24902
24903 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24904 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24905 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24906 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24907 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24908 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24909 packet).
24910
24911 @end table
24912
24913 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24914 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24915 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24916 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24917 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24918 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24919 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24920 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24921
24922 Replies:
24923 @table @samp
24924 @item OK
24925 The packet was understood and carried out.
24926 @item
24927 The packet was not recognized.
24928 @end table
24929
24930 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24931 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24932 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24933 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24934
24935 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24936 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24937 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24938 one of the following forms:
24939
24940 @table @samp
24941 @item F @var{f}
24942 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24943 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24944 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24945
24946 @item T @var{t}
24947 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24948 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24949
24950 @end table
24951
24952 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24953 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24954 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24955 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24956
24957 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24958 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24959 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24960 is a hexadecimal number.
24961
24962 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24963 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24964 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24965 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24966 numbers.
24967
24968 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24969 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24970 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24971
24972 @item QTStart
24973 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24974 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24975
24976 @item QTStop
24977 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24978
24979 @item QTinit
24980 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24981
24982 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24983 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24984 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24985 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24986
24987 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24988 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24989 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24990 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24991
24992 @item qTStatus
24993 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24994
24995 Replies:
24996 @table @samp
24997 @item T0
24998 There is no trace experiment running.
24999 @item T1
25000 There is a trace experiment running.
25001 @end table
25002
25003 @end table
25004
25005
25006 @node Host I/O Packets
25007 @section Host I/O Packets
25008 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25009 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25010
25011 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25012 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25013 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25014 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25015 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25016 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25017 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25018 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25019 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25020 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25021
25022 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25023 its arguments. They have this format:
25024
25025 @table @samp
25026
25027 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25028 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25029 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25030 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25031 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25032 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25033 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25034 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25035 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25036
25037 @end table
25038
25039 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25040
25041 @table @samp
25042
25043 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25044 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25045 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25046 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25047 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25048 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25049 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25050 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25051 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25052 @var{attachment}.
25053
25054 @item
25055 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25056
25057 @end table
25058
25059 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25060
25061 @table @samp
25062 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25063 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25064 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25065 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25066 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25067 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25068 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25069
25070 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25071 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25072 -1 if an error occurs.
25073
25074 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25075 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25076 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25077 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25078 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25079 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25080 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25081 @var{count} was zero.
25082
25083 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25084 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25085 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25086 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25087 some characters were escaped.
25088
25089 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25090 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25091 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25092 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25093 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25094 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25095 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25096 error occurred.
25097
25098 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25099 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25100 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25101
25102 @end table
25103
25104 @node Interrupts
25105 @section Interrupts
25106 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25107
25108 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25109 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25110 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25111 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25112
25113 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25114 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25115 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25116 interfaces.
25117
25118 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25119 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25120 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25121 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25122 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25123 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25124 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25125 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25126
25127 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25128 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25129 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25130 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25131 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25132 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25133 program is stopped will be discarded.
25134
25135 @node Examples
25136 @section Examples
25137
25138 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25139 does not get any direct output:
25140
25141 @smallexample
25142 -> @code{R00}
25143 <- @code{+}
25144 @emph{target restarts}
25145 -> @code{?}
25146 <- @code{+}
25147 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25148 -> @code{+}
25149 @end smallexample
25150
25151 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25152
25153 @smallexample
25154 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25155 <- @code{+}
25156 -> @code{s}
25157 <- @code{+}
25158 @emph{time passes}
25159 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25160 -> @code{+}
25161 -> @code{g}
25162 <- @code{+}
25163 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25164 -> @code{+}
25165 @end smallexample
25166
25167 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25168 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25169 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25170
25171 @menu
25172 * File-I/O Overview::
25173 * Protocol Basics::
25174 * The F Request Packet::
25175 * The F Reply Packet::
25176 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25177 * Console I/O::
25178 * List of Supported Calls::
25179 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25180 * Constants::
25181 * File-I/O Examples::
25182 @end menu
25183
25184 @node File-I/O Overview
25185 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25186 @cindex file-i/o overview
25187
25188 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25189 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25190 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25191 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25192 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25193 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25194
25195 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25196 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25197 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25198 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25199 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25200
25201 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25202 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25203 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25204 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25205 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25206 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25207 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25208
25209 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25210 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25211 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25212 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25213 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25214
25215 @smallexample
25216 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25217 <- target requests 'system call X'
25218 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25219 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25220 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25221 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25222 @end smallexample
25223
25224 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25225 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25226 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25227 system are not supported by this protocol.
25228
25229 @node Protocol Basics
25230 @subsection Protocol Basics
25231 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25232
25233 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25234 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25235 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25236 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25237 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25238 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25239 to call the appropriate host system call:
25240
25241 @itemize @bullet
25242 @item
25243 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25244
25245 @item
25246 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25247 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25248 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25249 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25250
25251 @end itemize
25252
25253 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25254
25255 @itemize @bullet
25256 @item
25257 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25258 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25259 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25260 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25261 packet.
25262
25263 @item
25264 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25265 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25266
25267 @item
25268 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25269
25270 @item
25271 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25272
25273 @item
25274 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25275 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25276 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25277 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25278 packet.
25279
25280 @end itemize
25281
25282 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25283 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25284
25285 @itemize @bullet
25286 @item
25287 Return value.
25288
25289 @item
25290 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25291
25292 @item
25293 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25294
25295 @end itemize
25296
25297 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25298 the latest continue or step action.
25299
25300 @node The F Request Packet
25301 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25302 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25303 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25304
25305 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25306
25307 @table @samp
25308 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25309
25310 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25311 This is just the name of the function.
25312
25313 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25314 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25315 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25316 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25317 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25318 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25319 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25320
25321 @end table
25322
25323
25324
25325 @node The F Reply Packet
25326 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25327 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25328 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25329
25330 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25331
25332 @table @samp
25333
25334 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25335
25336 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25337
25338 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25339 representation.
25340 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25341
25342 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25343 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25344 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25345
25346 @smallexample
25347 F0,0,C
25348 @end smallexample
25349
25350 @noindent
25351 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25352
25353 @smallexample
25354 F-1,4,C
25355 @end smallexample
25356
25357 @noindent
25358 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25359
25360 @end table
25361
25362
25363 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25364 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25365 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25366
25367 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25368 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25369 the target should behave as if it had
25370 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25371 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25372 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25373 packet.
25374
25375 It's important for the target to know in which
25376 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25377
25378 @itemize @bullet
25379 @item
25380 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25381
25382 @item
25383 The system call on the host has been finished.
25384
25385 @end itemize
25386
25387 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25388 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25389 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25390 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25391 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25392 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25393
25394 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25395 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25396 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25397 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25398 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25399 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25400 or the full action has been completed.
25401
25402 @node Console I/O
25403 @subsection Console I/O
25404 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25405
25406 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25407 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25408 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25409 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25410 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25411 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25412 conditions is met:
25413
25414 @itemize @bullet
25415 @item
25416 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25417 @code{read}
25418 system call is treated as finished.
25419
25420 @item
25421 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25422 newline.
25423
25424 @item
25425 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25426 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25427
25428 @end itemize
25429
25430 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25431 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25432 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25433 is stopped at the user's request.
25434
25435
25436 @node List of Supported Calls
25437 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25438 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25439
25440 @menu
25441 * open::
25442 * close::
25443 * read::
25444 * write::
25445 * lseek::
25446 * rename::
25447 * unlink::
25448 * stat/fstat::
25449 * gettimeofday::
25450 * isatty::
25451 * system::
25452 @end menu
25453
25454 @node open
25455 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25456 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25457
25458 @table @asis
25459 @item Synopsis:
25460 @smallexample
25461 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25462 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25463 @end smallexample
25464
25465 @item Request:
25466 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25467
25468 @noindent
25469 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25470
25471 @table @code
25472 @item O_CREAT
25473 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25474 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25475 are concerned.
25476
25477 @item O_EXCL
25478 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25479 an error and open() fails.
25480
25481 @item O_TRUNC
25482 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25483 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25484 truncated to zero length.
25485
25486 @item O_APPEND
25487 The file is opened in append mode.
25488
25489 @item O_RDONLY
25490 The file is opened for reading only.
25491
25492 @item O_WRONLY
25493 The file is opened for writing only.
25494
25495 @item O_RDWR
25496 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25497 @end table
25498
25499 @noindent
25500 Other bits are silently ignored.
25501
25502
25503 @noindent
25504 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25505
25506 @table @code
25507 @item S_IRUSR
25508 User has read permission.
25509
25510 @item S_IWUSR
25511 User has write permission.
25512
25513 @item S_IRGRP
25514 Group has read permission.
25515
25516 @item S_IWGRP
25517 Group has write permission.
25518
25519 @item S_IROTH
25520 Others have read permission.
25521
25522 @item S_IWOTH
25523 Others have write permission.
25524 @end table
25525
25526 @noindent
25527 Other bits are silently ignored.
25528
25529
25530 @item Return value:
25531 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25532 occurred.
25533
25534 @item Errors:
25535
25536 @table @code
25537 @item EEXIST
25538 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25539
25540 @item EISDIR
25541 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25542
25543 @item EACCES
25544 The requested access is not allowed.
25545
25546 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25547 @var{pathname} was too long.
25548
25549 @item ENOENT
25550 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25551
25552 @item ENODEV
25553 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25554
25555 @item EROFS
25556 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25557 write access was requested.
25558
25559 @item EFAULT
25560 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25561
25562 @item ENOSPC
25563 No space on device to create the file.
25564
25565 @item EMFILE
25566 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25567
25568 @item ENFILE
25569 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25570 has been reached.
25571
25572 @item EINTR
25573 The call was interrupted by the user.
25574 @end table
25575
25576 @end table
25577
25578 @node close
25579 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25580 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25581
25582 @table @asis
25583 @item Synopsis:
25584 @smallexample
25585 int close(int fd);
25586 @end smallexample
25587
25588 @item Request:
25589 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25590
25591 @item Return value:
25592 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25593
25594 @item Errors:
25595
25596 @table @code
25597 @item EBADF
25598 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25599
25600 @item EINTR
25601 The call was interrupted by the user.
25602 @end table
25603
25604 @end table
25605
25606 @node read
25607 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25608 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25609
25610 @table @asis
25611 @item Synopsis:
25612 @smallexample
25613 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25614 @end smallexample
25615
25616 @item Request:
25617 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25618
25619 @item Return value:
25620 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25621 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25622 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25623
25624 @item Errors:
25625
25626 @table @code
25627 @item EBADF
25628 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25629 reading.
25630
25631 @item EFAULT
25632 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25633
25634 @item EINTR
25635 The call was interrupted by the user.
25636 @end table
25637
25638 @end table
25639
25640 @node write
25641 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25642 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25643
25644 @table @asis
25645 @item Synopsis:
25646 @smallexample
25647 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 @item Request:
25651 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25652
25653 @item Return value:
25654 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25655 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25656 is returned.
25657
25658 @item Errors:
25659
25660 @table @code
25661 @item EBADF
25662 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25663 writing.
25664
25665 @item EFAULT
25666 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25667
25668 @item EFBIG
25669 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25670 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25671
25672 @item ENOSPC
25673 No space on device to write the data.
25674
25675 @item EINTR
25676 The call was interrupted by the user.
25677 @end table
25678
25679 @end table
25680
25681 @node lseek
25682 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25683 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25684
25685 @table @asis
25686 @item Synopsis:
25687 @smallexample
25688 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25689 @end smallexample
25690
25691 @item Request:
25692 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25693
25694 @var{flag} is one of:
25695
25696 @table @code
25697 @item SEEK_SET
25698 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25699
25700 @item SEEK_CUR
25701 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25702 bytes.
25703
25704 @item SEEK_END
25705 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25706 bytes.
25707 @end table
25708
25709 @item Return value:
25710 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25711 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25712 value of -1 is returned.
25713
25714 @item Errors:
25715
25716 @table @code
25717 @item EBADF
25718 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25719
25720 @item ESPIPE
25721 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25722
25723 @item EINVAL
25724 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25725
25726 @item EINTR
25727 The call was interrupted by the user.
25728 @end table
25729
25730 @end table
25731
25732 @node rename
25733 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25734 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25735
25736 @table @asis
25737 @item Synopsis:
25738 @smallexample
25739 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25740 @end smallexample
25741
25742 @item Request:
25743 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25744
25745 @item Return value:
25746 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25747
25748 @item Errors:
25749
25750 @table @code
25751 @item EISDIR
25752 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25753 directory.
25754
25755 @item EEXIST
25756 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25757
25758 @item EBUSY
25759 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25760 process.
25761
25762 @item EINVAL
25763 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25764 of itself.
25765
25766 @item ENOTDIR
25767 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25768 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25769 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25770
25771 @item EFAULT
25772 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25773
25774 @item EACCES
25775 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25776
25777 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25778
25779 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25780
25781 @item ENOENT
25782 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25783
25784 @item EROFS
25785 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25786
25787 @item ENOSPC
25788 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25789 directory entry.
25790
25791 @item EINTR
25792 The call was interrupted by the user.
25793 @end table
25794
25795 @end table
25796
25797 @node unlink
25798 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25799 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25800
25801 @table @asis
25802 @item Synopsis:
25803 @smallexample
25804 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25805 @end smallexample
25806
25807 @item Request:
25808 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25809
25810 @item Return value:
25811 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25812
25813 @item Errors:
25814
25815 @table @code
25816 @item EACCES
25817 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25818
25819 @item EPERM
25820 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25821
25822 @item EBUSY
25823 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25824 being used by another process.
25825
25826 @item EFAULT
25827 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25828
25829 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25830 @var{pathname} was too long.
25831
25832 @item ENOENT
25833 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25834
25835 @item ENOTDIR
25836 A component of the path is not a directory.
25837
25838 @item EROFS
25839 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25840
25841 @item EINTR
25842 The call was interrupted by the user.
25843 @end table
25844
25845 @end table
25846
25847 @node stat/fstat
25848 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25849 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25850 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25851
25852 @table @asis
25853 @item Synopsis:
25854 @smallexample
25855 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25856 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25857 @end smallexample
25858
25859 @item Request:
25860 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25861 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25862
25863 @item Return value:
25864 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25865
25866 @item Errors:
25867
25868 @table @code
25869 @item EBADF
25870 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25871
25872 @item ENOENT
25873 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25874 path is an empty string.
25875
25876 @item ENOTDIR
25877 A component of the path is not a directory.
25878
25879 @item EFAULT
25880 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25881
25882 @item EACCES
25883 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25884
25885 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25886 @var{pathname} was too long.
25887
25888 @item EINTR
25889 The call was interrupted by the user.
25890 @end table
25891
25892 @end table
25893
25894 @node gettimeofday
25895 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25896 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25897
25898 @table @asis
25899 @item Synopsis:
25900 @smallexample
25901 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25902 @end smallexample
25903
25904 @item Request:
25905 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25906
25907 @item Return value:
25908 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25909
25910 @item Errors:
25911
25912 @table @code
25913 @item EINVAL
25914 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25915
25916 @item EFAULT
25917 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25918 @end table
25919
25920 @end table
25921
25922 @node isatty
25923 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25924 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25925
25926 @table @asis
25927 @item Synopsis:
25928 @smallexample
25929 int isatty(int fd);
25930 @end smallexample
25931
25932 @item Request:
25933 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25934
25935 @item Return value:
25936 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25937
25938 @item Errors:
25939
25940 @table @code
25941 @item EINTR
25942 The call was interrupted by the user.
25943 @end table
25944
25945 @end table
25946
25947 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25948 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25949 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25950 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25951 needed.
25952
25953
25954 @node system
25955 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25956 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25957
25958 @table @asis
25959 @item Synopsis:
25960 @smallexample
25961 int system(const char *command);
25962 @end smallexample
25963
25964 @item Request:
25965 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25966
25967 @item Return value:
25968 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25969 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25970 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25971 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25972 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25973 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25974 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25975
25976 @item Errors:
25977
25978 @table @code
25979 @item EINTR
25980 The call was interrupted by the user.
25981 @end table
25982
25983 @end table
25984
25985 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25986 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25987 the host is simplified before it's returned
25988 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25989 is discarded, and the return value consists
25990 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25991
25992 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25993 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25994 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25995
25996 @table @code
25997 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25998 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25999 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26000 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26001
26002 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26003 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26004 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26005 protocol.
26006 @end table
26007
26008 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26009 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26010 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26011
26012 @menu
26013 * Integral Datatypes::
26014 * Pointer Values::
26015 * Memory Transfer::
26016 * struct stat::
26017 * struct timeval::
26018 @end menu
26019
26020 @node Integral Datatypes
26021 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26022 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26023
26024 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26025 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26026 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26027
26028 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26029 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26030
26031 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26032
26033 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26034 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26035
26036 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26037
26038 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26039 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26040 byte order.
26041
26042 @node Pointer Values
26043 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26044 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26045
26046 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26047 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26048 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26049 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26050
26051 @smallexample
26052 @code{1aaf/12}
26053 @end smallexample
26054
26055 @noindent
26056 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26057 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26058 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26059 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26060
26061 @smallexample
26062 @code{123456/d}
26063 @end smallexample
26064
26065 @node Memory Transfer
26066 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26067 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26068
26069 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26070 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26071 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26072 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26073 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26074 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26075 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26076
26077
26078 @node struct stat
26079 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26080 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26081
26082 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26083 is defined as follows:
26084
26085 @smallexample
26086 struct stat @{
26087 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26088 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26089 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26090 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26091 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26092 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26093 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26094 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26095 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26096 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26097 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26098 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26099 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26100 @};
26101 @end smallexample
26102
26103 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26104 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26105 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26106
26107 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26108 range of values.
26109
26110 @table @code
26111
26112 @item st_dev
26113 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26114
26115 @item st_ino
26116 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26117
26118 @item st_mode
26119 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26120 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26121
26122 @item st_uid
26123 @itemx st_gid
26124 @itemx st_rdev
26125 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26126
26127 @item st_atime
26128 @itemx st_mtime
26129 @itemx st_ctime
26130 These values have a host and file system dependent
26131 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26132 support exact timing values.
26133 @end table
26134
26135 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26136 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26137 continuing.
26138
26139 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26140 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26141 get truncated on the target.
26142
26143 @node struct timeval
26144 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26145 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26146
26147 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26148 is defined as follows:
26149
26150 @smallexample
26151 struct timeval @{
26152 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26153 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26154 @};
26155 @end smallexample
26156
26157 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26158 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26159 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26160
26161 @node Constants
26162 @subsection Constants
26163 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26164
26165 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26166 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26167 values before and after the call as needed.
26168
26169 @menu
26170 * Open Flags::
26171 * mode_t Values::
26172 * Errno Values::
26173 * Lseek Flags::
26174 * Limits::
26175 @end menu
26176
26177 @node Open Flags
26178 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26179 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26180
26181 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26182
26183 @smallexample
26184 O_RDONLY 0x0
26185 O_WRONLY 0x1
26186 O_RDWR 0x2
26187 O_APPEND 0x8
26188 O_CREAT 0x200
26189 O_TRUNC 0x400
26190 O_EXCL 0x800
26191 @end smallexample
26192
26193 @node mode_t Values
26194 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26195 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26196
26197 All values are given in octal representation.
26198
26199 @smallexample
26200 S_IFREG 0100000
26201 S_IFDIR 040000
26202 S_IRUSR 0400
26203 S_IWUSR 0200
26204 S_IXUSR 0100
26205 S_IRGRP 040
26206 S_IWGRP 020
26207 S_IXGRP 010
26208 S_IROTH 04
26209 S_IWOTH 02
26210 S_IXOTH 01
26211 @end smallexample
26212
26213 @node Errno Values
26214 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26215 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26216
26217 All values are given in decimal representation.
26218
26219 @smallexample
26220 EPERM 1
26221 ENOENT 2
26222 EINTR 4
26223 EBADF 9
26224 EACCES 13
26225 EFAULT 14
26226 EBUSY 16
26227 EEXIST 17
26228 ENODEV 19
26229 ENOTDIR 20
26230 EISDIR 21
26231 EINVAL 22
26232 ENFILE 23
26233 EMFILE 24
26234 EFBIG 27
26235 ENOSPC 28
26236 ESPIPE 29
26237 EROFS 30
26238 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26239 EUNKNOWN 9999
26240 @end smallexample
26241
26242 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26243 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26244
26245 @node Lseek Flags
26246 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26247 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26248
26249 @smallexample
26250 SEEK_SET 0
26251 SEEK_CUR 1
26252 SEEK_END 2
26253 @end smallexample
26254
26255 @node Limits
26256 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26257 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26258
26259 All values are given in decimal representation.
26260
26261 @smallexample
26262 INT_MIN -2147483648
26263 INT_MAX 2147483647
26264 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26265 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26266 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26267 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26268 @end smallexample
26269
26270 @node File-I/O Examples
26271 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26272 @cindex file-i/o examples
26273
26274 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26275 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26276
26277 @smallexample
26278 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26279 @emph{request memory read from target}
26280 -> @code{m1234,6}
26281 <- XXXXXX
26282 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26283 -> @code{F6}
26284 @end smallexample
26285
26286 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26287 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26291 @emph{request memory write to target}
26292 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26293 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26294 -> @code{F6}
26295 @end smallexample
26296
26297 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26298 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26299
26300 @smallexample
26301 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26302 -> @code{F-1,9}
26303 @end smallexample
26304
26305 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26306 host is called:
26307
26308 @smallexample
26309 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26310 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26311 <- @code{T02}
26312 @end smallexample
26313
26314 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26315 host is called:
26316
26317 @smallexample
26318 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26319 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26320 <- @code{T02}
26321 @end smallexample
26322
26323 @node Library List Format
26324 @section Library List Format
26325 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26326
26327 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26328 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26329 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26330 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26331 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26332 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26333 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26334 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26335 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26336 are loaded.
26337
26338 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26339 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26340 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26341 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26342
26343 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26344 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26345 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26346 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26347 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26348 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26349
26350 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26351 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26352
26353 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26354 offset, looks like this:
26355
26356 @smallexample
26357 <library-list>
26358 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26359 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26360 </library>
26361 </library-list>
26362 @end smallexample
26363
26364 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26365 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26366
26367 @smallexample
26368 <library-list>
26369 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26370 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26371 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26372 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26373 </library>
26374 </library-list>
26375 @end smallexample
26376
26377 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26378
26379 @smallexample
26380 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26381 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26382 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26383 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26384 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26385 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26386 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26387 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26388 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26389 @end smallexample
26390
26391 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26392 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26393 section for each library.
26394
26395 @node Memory Map Format
26396 @section Memory Map Format
26397 @cindex memory map format
26398
26399 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26400 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26401 memory map.
26402
26403 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26404 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26405 lists memory regions.
26406
26407 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26408 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26409
26410 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26411
26412 @smallexample
26413 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26414 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26415 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26416 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26417 <memory-map>
26418 region...
26419 </memory-map>
26420 @end smallexample
26421
26422 Each region can be either:
26423
26424 @itemize
26425
26426 @item
26427 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26428 bytes from there:
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26432 @end smallexample
26433
26434
26435 @item
26436 A region of read-only memory:
26437
26438 @smallexample
26439 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26440 @end smallexample
26441
26442
26443 @item
26444 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26445 bytes in length:
26446
26447 @smallexample
26448 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26449 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26450 </memory>
26451 @end smallexample
26452
26453 @end itemize
26454
26455 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26456 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26457 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26458
26459 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26460
26461 @smallexample
26462 <!-- ................................................... -->
26463 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26464 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26465 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26466 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26467 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26468 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26469 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26470 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26471 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26472 and its type, or device. -->
26473 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26474 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26475 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26476 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26477 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26478 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26479 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26480 @end smallexample
26481
26482 @include agentexpr.texi
26483
26484 @node Target Descriptions
26485 @appendix Target Descriptions
26486 @cindex target descriptions
26487
26488 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26489 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26490 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26491
26492 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26493 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26494 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26495 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26496 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26497 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26498 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26499
26500 @itemize @bullet
26501 @item
26502 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26503 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26504 @item
26505 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26506 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26507 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26508 @item
26509 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26510 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26511 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26512 @end itemize
26513
26514 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26515 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26516 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26517 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26518 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26519
26520 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26521 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26522
26523 @menu
26524 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26525 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26526 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26527 descriptions.
26528 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26529 @end menu
26530
26531 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26532 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26533
26534 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26535 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26536 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26537 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26538 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26539 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26540 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26541 Format}.
26542
26543 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26544 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26545 specify a file are:
26546
26547 @table @code
26548 @cindex set tdesc filename
26549 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26550 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26551
26552 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26553 @item unset tdesc filename
26554 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26555 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26556
26557 @cindex show tdesc filename
26558 @item show tdesc filename
26559 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26560 @end table
26561
26562
26563 @node Target Description Format
26564 @section Target Description Format
26565 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26566
26567 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26568 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26569 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26570 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26571 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26572 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26573 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26574
26575 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26576 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26577 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26578 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26579
26580 Here is a simple target description:
26581
26582 @smallexample
26583 <target version="1.0">
26584 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26585 </target>
26586 @end smallexample
26587
26588 @noindent
26589 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26590 the x86-64 architecture.
26591
26592 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26593 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26594 are explained further below.
26595
26596 @smallexample
26597 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26598 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26599 <target version="1.0">
26600 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26601 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26602 </target>
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 @noindent
26606 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26607 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26608 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26609 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26610 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26611 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26612 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26613 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26614 the version mismatch.
26615
26616 @subsection Inclusion
26617 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26618 @cindex XInclude
26619 @ifnotinfo
26620 @cindex <xi:include>
26621 @end ifnotinfo
26622
26623 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26624 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26625 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26626 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26627 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26628
26629 @smallexample
26630 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26631 @end smallexample
26632
26633 @noindent
26634 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26635 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26636 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26637 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26638 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26639 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26640 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26641 original description.
26642
26643 @subsection Architecture
26644 @cindex <architecture>
26645
26646 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26647
26648 @smallexample
26649 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26653 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26654 Debugging Target}).
26655
26656 @subsection Features
26657 @cindex <feature>
26658
26659 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26660 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26661 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26662 has this form:
26663
26664 @smallexample
26665 <feature name="@var{name}">
26666 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26667 @var{reg}@dots{}
26668 </feature>
26669 @end smallexample
26670
26671 @noindent
26672 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26673 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26674 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26675 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26676
26677 @subsection Types
26678
26679 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26680 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26681 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26682 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26683 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26684
26685 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26686 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26687 Types must be defined before they are used.
26688
26689 @cindex <vector>
26690 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26691 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26692 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26693 @var{count}:
26694
26695 @smallexample
26696 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26697 @end smallexample
26698
26699 @cindex <union>
26700 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26701 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26702 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26703 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26704
26705 @smallexample
26706 <union id="@var{id}">
26707 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26708 @dots{}
26709 </union>
26710 @end smallexample
26711
26712 @subsection Registers
26713 @cindex <reg>
26714
26715 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26716
26717 @smallexample
26718 <reg name="@var{name}"
26719 bitsize="@var{size}"
26720 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26721 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26722 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26723 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26724 @end smallexample
26725
26726 @noindent
26727 The components are as follows:
26728
26729 @table @var
26730
26731 @item name
26732 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26733
26734 @item bitsize
26735 The register's size, in bits.
26736
26737 @item regnum
26738 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26739 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26740 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26741 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26742 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26743 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26744 in order of increasing register number.
26745
26746 @item save-restore
26747 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26748 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26749 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26750 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26751 ABI.
26752
26753 @item type
26754 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26755 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26756 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26757 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26758 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26759 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26760
26761 @item group
26762 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26763 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26764 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26765 in @code{info registers}.
26766
26767 @end table
26768
26769 @node Predefined Target Types
26770 @section Predefined Target Types
26771 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26772
26773 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26774 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26775 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26776 types. The currently supported types are:
26777
26778 @table @code
26779
26780 @item int8
26781 @itemx int16
26782 @itemx int32
26783 @itemx int64
26784 @itemx int128
26785 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26786
26787 @item uint8
26788 @itemx uint16
26789 @itemx uint32
26790 @itemx uint64
26791 @itemx uint128
26792 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26793
26794 @item code_ptr
26795 @itemx data_ptr
26796 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26797 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26798 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26799 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26800 may be marked as data pointers.
26801
26802 @item ieee_single
26803 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26804
26805 @item ieee_double
26806 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26807
26808 @item arm_fpa_ext
26809 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26810
26811 @end table
26812
26813 @node Standard Target Features
26814 @section Standard Target Features
26815 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26816
26817 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26818 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26819 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26820 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26821 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26822 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26823 can recognize them.
26824
26825 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26826 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26827 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26828 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26829 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26830 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26831 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26832 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26833
26834 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26835 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26836 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26837
26838 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26839 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26840 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26841 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26842
26843 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26844 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26845 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26846
26847 @menu
26848 * ARM Features::
26849 * M68K Features::
26850 @end menu
26851
26852
26853 @node ARM Features
26854 @subsection ARM Features
26855 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26856
26857 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26858 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26859 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26860
26861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26862 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26863
26864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26865 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26866 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26867 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26868
26869 @subsection MIPS Features
26870 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26871
26872 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26873 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26874 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26875 on the target.
26876
26877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26878 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26879 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26880
26881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26882 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26883 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26884 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26885
26886 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26887 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26888 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26889
26890 @node M68K Features
26891 @subsection M68K Features
26892 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26893
26894 @table @code
26895 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26896 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26897 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26898 One of those features must be always present.
26899 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26900 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26901 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26902 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26903
26904 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26905 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26906 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26907 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26908 @end table
26909
26910 @subsection PowerPC Features
26911 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26912
26913 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26914 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26915 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26916 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26917
26918 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26919 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26920
26921 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26922 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26923 and @samp{vrsave}.
26924
26925 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26926 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26927 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26928 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26929 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26930 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26931 user.
26932
26933 @include gpl.texi
26934
26935 @raisesections
26936 @include fdl.texi
26937 @lowersections
26938
26939 @node Index
26940 @unnumbered Index
26941
26942 @printindex cp
26943
26944 @tex
26945 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26946 % meantime:
26947 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26948 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26949 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26950 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26951 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26952 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26953 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26954 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26955 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26956 \page\colophon
26957 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26958 @end tex
26959
26960 @bye
This page took 0.663267 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.